1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
2 //
3 //                     The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4 //
5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7 //
8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9 //
10 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11 //
12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13 
14 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
22 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
23 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h"
24 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
25 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
26 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
27 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
28 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
29 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
30 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
31 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
32 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
33 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
34 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
35 #include <algorithm>
36 #include <cstdlib>
37 
38 namespace clang {
39 using namespace sema;
40 
41 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
42 static ExprResult
43 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
44                       bool HadMultipleCandidates,
45                       SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
46                       const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
47   if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc))
48     return ExprError();
49   // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template
50   // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
51   // called on both.
52   // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
53   // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
54   // being used.
55   if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc))
56     return ExprError();
57   DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(),
58                                                  VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
59   if (HadMultipleCandidates)
60     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
61 
62   S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
63 
64   ExprResult E = DRE;
65   E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.get());
66   if (E.isInvalid())
67     return ExprError();
68   return E;
69 }
70 
71 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
72                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
73                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
74                                  bool CStyle,
75                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
76 
77 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
78                                                  QualType &ToType,
79                                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
80                                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
81                                                  bool CStyle);
82 static OverloadingResult
83 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
84                         UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
85                         OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
86                         bool AllowExplicit,
87                         bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
88 
89 
90 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
91 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
92                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
93                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
94 
95 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
96 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
97                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
98                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
99 
100 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
101 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
102                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
103                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
104 
105 
106 
107 /// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
108 /// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
109 ImplicitConversionCategory
110 GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
111   static const ImplicitConversionCategory
112     Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
113     ICC_Identity,
114     ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
115     ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
116     ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
117     ICC_Identity,
118     ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
119     ICC_Promotion,
120     ICC_Promotion,
121     ICC_Promotion,
122     ICC_Conversion,
123     ICC_Conversion,
124     ICC_Conversion,
125     ICC_Conversion,
126     ICC_Conversion,
127     ICC_Conversion,
128     ICC_Conversion,
129     ICC_Conversion,
130     ICC_Conversion,
131     ICC_Conversion,
132     ICC_Conversion,
133     ICC_Conversion,
134     ICC_Conversion
135   };
136   return Category[(int)Kind];
137 }
138 
139 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
140 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
141 ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
142   static const ImplicitConversionRank
143     Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
144     ICR_Exact_Match,
145     ICR_Exact_Match,
146     ICR_Exact_Match,
147     ICR_Exact_Match,
148     ICR_Exact_Match,
149     ICR_Exact_Match,
150     ICR_Promotion,
151     ICR_Promotion,
152     ICR_Promotion,
153     ICR_Conversion,
154     ICR_Conversion,
155     ICR_Conversion,
156     ICR_Conversion,
157     ICR_Conversion,
158     ICR_Conversion,
159     ICR_Conversion,
160     ICR_Conversion,
161     ICR_Conversion,
162     ICR_Conversion,
163     ICR_Conversion,
164     ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
165     ICR_Conversion,
166     ICR_Conversion,
167     ICR_Writeback_Conversion
168   };
169   return Rank[(int)Kind];
170 }
171 
172 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
173 /// implicit conversion.
174 const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
175   static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
176     "No conversion",
177     "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
178     "Array-to-pointer",
179     "Function-to-pointer",
180     "Noreturn adjustment",
181     "Qualification",
182     "Integral promotion",
183     "Floating point promotion",
184     "Complex promotion",
185     "Integral conversion",
186     "Floating conversion",
187     "Complex conversion",
188     "Floating-integral conversion",
189     "Pointer conversion",
190     "Pointer-to-member conversion",
191     "Boolean conversion",
192     "Compatible-types conversion",
193     "Derived-to-base conversion",
194     "Vector conversion",
195     "Vector splat",
196     "Complex-real conversion",
197     "Block Pointer conversion",
198     "Transparent Union Conversion"
199     "Writeback conversion"
200   };
201   return Name[Kind];
202 }
203 
204 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
205 /// sequence to the identity conversion.
206 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
207   First = ICK_Identity;
208   Second = ICK_Identity;
209   Third = ICK_Identity;
210   DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
211   QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
212   ReferenceBinding = false;
213   DirectBinding = false;
214   IsLvalueReference = true;
215   BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
216   BindsToRvalue = false;
217   BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
218   ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
219   CopyConstructor = nullptr;
220 }
221 
222 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
223 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
224 /// implicit conversions.
225 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
226   ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
227   if  (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
228     Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
229   if  (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
230     Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
231   if  (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
232     Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
233   return Rank;
234 }
235 
236 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
237 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
238 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
239 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
240 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
241   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
242   // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
243   // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
244   // a pointer.
245   if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
246       (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
247        getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
248        getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
249        getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
250        First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
251     return true;
252 
253   return false;
254 }
255 
256 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
257 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
258 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
259 /// 13.3.3.2p4).
260 bool
261 StandardConversionSequence::
262 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
263   QualType FromType = getFromType();
264   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
265 
266   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
267   // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
268   // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
269   if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
270     FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
271 
272   if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
273     if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
274       return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
275 
276   return false;
277 }
278 
279 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
280 /// or after one in an implicit conversion.
281 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
282   while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
283     switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
284     case CK_NoOp:
285     case CK_IntegralCast:
286     case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
287     case CK_IntegralToFloating:
288     case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
289     case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
290     case CK_FloatingCast:
291       Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
292       continue;
293 
294     default:
295       return Converted;
296     }
297   }
298 
299   return Converted;
300 }
301 
302 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
303 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
304 ///
305 /// \param Ctx  The AST context.
306 /// \param Converted  The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
307 /// \param ConstantValue  If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
308 ///        value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
309 /// \param ConstantType  If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
310 ///        type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
311 NarrowingKind
312 StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx,
313                                              const Expr *Converted,
314                                              APValue &ConstantValue,
315                                              QualType &ConstantType) const {
316   assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
317 
318   // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
319   //   A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
320   QualType FromType = getToType(0);
321   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
322   switch (Second) {
323   // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
324   //
325   // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
326   //    type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
327   //    value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
328   //    the original value when converted back to the original type, or
329   case ICK_Floating_Integral:
330     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
331       return NK_Type_Narrowing;
332     } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
333       llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
334       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
335       if (Initializer &&
336           Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
337         // Convert the integer to the floating type.
338         llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
339         Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
340                                 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
341         // And back.
342         llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
343         bool ignored;
344         Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
345                                 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
346         // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
347         if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
348           ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
349           ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
350           return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
351         }
352       } else {
353         // Variables are always narrowings.
354         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
355       }
356     }
357     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
358 
359   // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
360   //    where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
361   //    conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
362   //    if it cannot be represented exactly), or
363   case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
364     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
365         Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
366       // FromType is larger than ToType.
367       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
368       if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
369         // Constant!
370         assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
371         llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
372         // Convert the source value into the target type.
373         bool ignored;
374         llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
375           Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
376           llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
377         // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
378         // values that can be represented.
379         if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
380           ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
381           return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
382         }
383       } else {
384         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
385       }
386     }
387     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
388 
389   // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
390   //    that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
391   //    the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
392   //    conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
393   //    value when converted back to the original type.
394   case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:  // Bools are integers too.
395     if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
396       // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
397       // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
398       return NK_Not_Narrowing;
399     }  // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case.
400   case ICK_Integral_Conversion: {
401     assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
402     assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
403     const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
404     const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
405     const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
406     const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
407 
408     if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
409         (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
410         (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
411       // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
412       llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
413       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
414       if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
415         // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
416         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
417       }
418       bool Narrowing = false;
419       if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
420         // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
421         // narrowing.
422         if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
423           Narrowing = true;
424       } else {
425         // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
426         // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
427         InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
428           InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
429         // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
430         llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
431         ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
432         ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
433         ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
434         ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
435         // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
436         if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
437           Narrowing = true;
438       }
439       if (Narrowing) {
440         ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
441         ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
442         return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
443       }
444     }
445     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
446   }
447 
448   default:
449     // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
450     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
451   }
452 }
453 
454 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
455 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
456 void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const {
457   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
458   bool PrintedSomething = false;
459   if (First != ICK_Identity) {
460     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
461     PrintedSomething = true;
462   }
463 
464   if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
465     if (PrintedSomething) {
466       OS << " -> ";
467     }
468     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
469 
470     if (CopyConstructor) {
471       OS << " (by copy constructor)";
472     } else if (DirectBinding) {
473       OS << " (direct reference binding)";
474     } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
475       OS << " (reference binding)";
476     }
477     PrintedSomething = true;
478   }
479 
480   if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
481     if (PrintedSomething) {
482       OS << " -> ";
483     }
484     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
485     PrintedSomething = true;
486   }
487 
488   if (!PrintedSomething) {
489     OS << "No conversions required";
490   }
491 }
492 
493 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
494 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
495 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const {
496   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
497   if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
498     Before.dump();
499     OS << " -> ";
500   }
501   if (ConversionFunction)
502     OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
503   else
504     OS << "aggregate initialization";
505   if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
506     OS << " -> ";
507     After.dump();
508   }
509 }
510 
511 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
512 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
513 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const {
514   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
515   if (isStdInitializerListElement())
516     OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: ";
517   switch (ConversionKind) {
518   case StandardConversion:
519     OS << "Standard conversion: ";
520     Standard.dump();
521     break;
522   case UserDefinedConversion:
523     OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
524     UserDefined.dump();
525     break;
526   case EllipsisConversion:
527     OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
528     break;
529   case AmbiguousConversion:
530     OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
531     break;
532   case BadConversion:
533     OS << "Bad conversion";
534     break;
535   }
536 
537   OS << "\n";
538 }
539 
540 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
541   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
542 }
543 
544 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
545   conversions().~ConversionSet();
546 }
547 
548 void
549 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
550   FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
551   ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
552   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
553 }
554 
555 namespace {
556   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
557   // template argument information.
558   struct DFIArguments {
559     TemplateArgument FirstArg;
560     TemplateArgument SecondArg;
561   };
562   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
563   // template parameter and template argument information.
564   struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
565     TemplateParameter Param;
566   };
567 }
568 
569 /// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
570 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
571 DeductionFailureInfo MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
572                                               Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
573                                               TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
574   DeductionFailureInfo Result;
575   Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
576   Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
577   Result.Data = nullptr;
578   switch (TDK) {
579   case Sema::TDK_Success:
580   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
581   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
582   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
583   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
584     break;
585 
586   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
587   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
588     Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
589     break;
590 
591   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
592     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
593     DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
594     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
595     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
596     Result.Data = Saved;
597     break;
598   }
599 
600   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
601   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
602     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
603     DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
604     Saved->Param = Info.Param;
605     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
606     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
607     Result.Data = Saved;
608     break;
609   }
610 
611   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
612     Result.Data = Info.take();
613     if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
614       PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
615           SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
616       Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
617       Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
618     }
619     break;
620 
621   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
622     Result.Data = Info.Expression;
623     break;
624 
625   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
626     break;
627   }
628 
629   return Result;
630 }
631 
632 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
633   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
634   case Sema::TDK_Success:
635   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
636   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
637   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
638   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
639   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
640   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
641   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
642     break;
643 
644   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
645   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
646   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
647     // FIXME: Destroy the data?
648     Data = nullptr;
649     break;
650 
651   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
652     // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
653     Data = nullptr;
654     if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
655       Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
656       HasDiagnostic = false;
657     }
658     break;
659 
660   // Unhandled
661   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
662     break;
663   }
664 }
665 
666 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
667   if (HasDiagnostic)
668     return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
669   return nullptr;
670 }
671 
672 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
673   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
674   case Sema::TDK_Success:
675   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
676   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
677   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
678   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
679   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
680   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
681   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
682     return TemplateParameter();
683 
684   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
685   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
686     return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
687 
688   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
689   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
690     return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
691 
692   // Unhandled
693   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
694     break;
695   }
696 
697   return TemplateParameter();
698 }
699 
700 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
701   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
702   case Sema::TDK_Success:
703   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
704   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
705   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
706   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
707   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
708   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
709   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
710   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
711   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
712   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
713     return nullptr;
714 
715   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
716     return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
717 
718   // Unhandled
719   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
720     break;
721   }
722 
723   return nullptr;
724 }
725 
726 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
727   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
728   case Sema::TDK_Success:
729   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
730   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
731   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
732   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
733   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
734   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
735   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
736   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
737     return nullptr;
738 
739   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
740   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
741   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
742     return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
743 
744   // Unhandled
745   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
746     break;
747   }
748 
749   return nullptr;
750 }
751 
752 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
753   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
754   case Sema::TDK_Success:
755   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
756   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
757   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
758   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
759   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
760   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
761   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
762   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
763     return nullptr;
764 
765   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
766   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
767   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
768     return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
769 
770   // Unhandled
771   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
772     break;
773   }
774 
775   return nullptr;
776 }
777 
778 Expr *DeductionFailureInfo::getExpr() {
779   if (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result) ==
780         Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution)
781     return static_cast<Expr*>(Data);
782 
783   return nullptr;
784 }
785 
786 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
787   for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
788     for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii)
789       i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence();
790     if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
791       i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
792   }
793 }
794 
795 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
796   destroyCandidates();
797   NumInlineSequences = 0;
798   Candidates.clear();
799   Functions.clear();
800 }
801 
802 namespace {
803   class UnbridgedCastsSet {
804     struct Entry {
805       Expr **Addr;
806       Expr *Saved;
807     };
808     SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
809 
810   public:
811     void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
812       assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
813       Entry entry = { &E, E };
814       Entries.push_back(entry);
815       E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
816     }
817 
818     void restore() {
819       for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
820              i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
821         *i->Addr = i->Saved;
822     }
823   };
824 }
825 
826 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
827 /// preprocessing on the given expression.
828 ///
829 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
830 ///   without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
831 ///
832 /// Return true on unrecoverable error.
833 static bool
834 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
835                             UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) {
836   if (const BuiltinType *placeholder =  E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
837     // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
838     // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
839     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
840 
841     // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
842     // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
843     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
844         unbridgedCasts) {
845       unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
846       return false;
847     }
848 
849     // Go ahead and check everything else.
850     ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
851     if (result.isInvalid())
852       return true;
853 
854     E = result.get();
855     return false;
856   }
857 
858   // Nothing to do.
859   return false;
860 }
861 
862 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
863 /// placeholders.
864 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S,
865                                             MultiExprArg Args,
866                                             UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
867   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i)
868     if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged))
869       return true;
870 
871   return false;
872 }
873 
874 // IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
875 // overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
876 // New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
877 // signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
878 // declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
879 // it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
880 // cannot be overloaded with.  This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
881 // top of the underlying declaration.
882 //
883 // Example: Given the following input:
884 //
885 //   void f(int, float); // #1
886 //   void f(int, int); // #2
887 //   int f(int, int); // #3
888 //
889 // When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
890 // so IsOverload will not be used.
891 //
892 // When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1.  By
893 // comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
894 // (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
895 // false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
896 //
897 // When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
898 // compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
899 // nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
900 // identical (return types of functions are not part of the
901 // signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
902 // point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
903 //
904 // 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
905 // into a class by a using declaration.  The rules for whether to hide
906 // shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
907 // into a function template's signature.
908 Sema::OverloadKind
909 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
910                     NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
911   for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
912          I != E; ++I) {
913     NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
914 
915     bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
916     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
917       OldIsUsingDecl = true;
918 
919       // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
920       // context, even if they have identical signatures.
921       if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
922 
923       OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
924     }
925 
926     // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
927     // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
928     // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
929     // function templates hide function templates with different
930     // return types or template parameter lists.
931     bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
932       (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() &&
933       !New->getFriendObjectKind();
934 
935     if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) {
936       if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
937         if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
938           HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
939           continue;
940         }
941 
942         if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) &&
943             !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New))
944           continue;
945 
946         Match = *I;
947         return Ovl_Match;
948       }
949     } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
950       // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
951       // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
952       assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
953     } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
954       // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
955     } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
956       // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
957       // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
958       // template instantiation.
959     } else {
960       // (C++ 13p1):
961       //   Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
962       //   declarations cannot be overloaded.
963       Match = *I;
964       return Ovl_NonFunction;
965     }
966   }
967 
968   return Ovl_Overload;
969 }
970 
971 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
972                       bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
973   // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded.
974   if (New->isMain())
975     return false;
976 
977   // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded.
978   if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
979     return false;
980 
981   FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
982   FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
983 
984   // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
985   //   A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
986   //   and with normal (non-template) functions.
987   if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr))
988     return true;
989 
990   // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
991   QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
992   QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
993 
994   // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
995   // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
996   // in the signature, they are overloads.
997 
998   // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
999   // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
1000   if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
1001       isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
1002     return false;
1003 
1004   const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
1005   const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
1006 
1007   // The signature of a function includes the types of its
1008   // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
1009   // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
1010   if (OldQType != NewQType &&
1011       (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() ||
1012        OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
1013        !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
1014     return true;
1015 
1016   // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1017   //   The signature of a function template consists of its function
1018   //   signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1019   //   of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1020   //   relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1021   //   signature.
1022   //
1023   // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1024   // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
1025   //
1026   // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1027   // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1028   if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
1029       (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1030                                        OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1031                                        false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
1032        OldType->getReturnType() != NewType->getReturnType()))
1033     return true;
1034 
1035   // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
1036   // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
1037   //
1038   // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1039   // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1040   // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1041   // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1042   // can be overloaded.
1043   CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1044   CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
1045   if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
1046       !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1047     if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1048       if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
1049           (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1050            NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1051         // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1052         //   - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1053         //     parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1054         //     declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1055         //     the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1056         //     them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
1057         Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
1058           << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
1059         Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1060       }
1061       return true;
1062     }
1063 
1064     // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1065     // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1066     // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1067     // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
1068     unsigned OldQuals = OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
1069     unsigned NewQuals = NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
1070     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y && NewMethod->isConstexpr() &&
1071         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
1072       NewQuals |= Qualifiers::Const;
1073 
1074     // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'.
1075     OldQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict;
1076     NewQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict;
1077     if (OldQuals != NewQuals)
1078       return true;
1079   }
1080 
1081   // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature.
1082   for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr>
1083          NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1084          NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(),
1085          OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1086          OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>();
1087        NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) {
1088     if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE)
1089       return true;
1090     llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID;
1091     NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true);
1092     OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true);
1093     if (NewID != OldID)
1094       return true;
1095   }
1096 
1097   // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1098   return false;
1099 }
1100 
1101 /// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
1102 /// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
1103 ///
1104 /// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
1105 /// an available function, false otherwise.
1106 bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
1107   return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
1108 }
1109 
1110 /// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1111 ///
1112 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1113 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1114 static ImplicitConversionSequence
1115 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1116                          bool SuppressUserConversions,
1117                          bool AllowExplicit,
1118                          bool InOverloadResolution,
1119                          bool CStyle,
1120                          bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1121                          bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
1122   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1123 
1124   if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1125     // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1126     // we can perform.
1127     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1128     return ICS;
1129   }
1130 
1131   // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1132   OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(),
1133                                    OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
1134   OverloadingResult UserDefResult
1135     = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
1136                               AllowExplicit, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
1137 
1138   if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
1139     ICS.setUserDefined();
1140     ICS.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
1141     // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1142     //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1143     //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1144     //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1145     //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1146     //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1147     //   called for those cases.
1148     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1149           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1150       QualType FromCanon
1151         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1152       QualType ToCanon
1153         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1154       if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1155           (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1156         // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1157         // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1158         ICS.setStandard();
1159         ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1160         ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1161         ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1162         ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1163         if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1164           ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1165       }
1166     }
1167   } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
1168     ICS.setAmbiguous();
1169     ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1170     ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1171     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1172          Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1173       if (Cand->Viable)
1174         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
1175   } else {
1176     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1177   }
1178 
1179   return ICS;
1180 }
1181 
1182 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1183 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1184 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1185 /// to perform the initialization. Given
1186 ///
1187 ///   void f(float f);
1188 ///   void g(int i) { f(i); }
1189 ///
1190 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1191 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1192 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1193 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1194 //
1195 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1196 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1197 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1198 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1199 /// "BadConversion".
1200 ///
1201 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1202 /// not permitted.
1203 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1204 /// permitted.
1205 ///
1206 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1207 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1208 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
1209 static ImplicitConversionSequence
1210 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1211                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
1212                       bool AllowExplicit,
1213                       bool InOverloadResolution,
1214                       bool CStyle,
1215                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1216                       bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
1217   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1218   if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1219                            ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
1220     ICS.setStandard();
1221     return ICS;
1222   }
1223 
1224   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1225     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1226     return ICS;
1227   }
1228 
1229   // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1230   //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1231   //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1232   //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1233   //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1234   //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1235   //   called for those cases.
1236   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1237   if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
1238       (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1239        S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
1240     ICS.setStandard();
1241     ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1242     ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1243     ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1244 
1245     // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1246     // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1247     // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1248     // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1249     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
1250 
1251     // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
1252     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1253       ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1254 
1255     return ICS;
1256   }
1257 
1258   return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1259                                   AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1260                                   AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1261                                   AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
1262 }
1263 
1264 ImplicitConversionSequence
1265 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1266                             bool SuppressUserConversions,
1267                             bool AllowExplicit,
1268                             bool InOverloadResolution,
1269                             bool CStyle,
1270                             bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1271   return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1272                                       SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1273                                       InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1274                                       AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1275                                       /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
1276 }
1277 
1278 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
1279 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
1280 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1281 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1282 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
1283 ExprResult
1284 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1285                                 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
1286   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1287   return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
1288 }
1289 
1290 ExprResult
1291 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1292                                 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
1293                                 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
1294   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1295     return ExprError();
1296 
1297   // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1298   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
1299     = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
1300       (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
1301   if (getLangOpts().ObjC1)
1302     CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getLocStart(),
1303                                       ToType, From->getType(), From);
1304   ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1305                                      /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1306                                      AllowExplicit,
1307                                      /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
1308                                      /*CStyle=*/false,
1309                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1310                                      /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
1311   return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1312 }
1313 
1314 /// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1315 /// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
1316 bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1317                                 QualType &ResultTy) {
1318   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1319     return false;
1320 
1321   // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1322   // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1323   //   - a pointer
1324   //   - a member pointer
1325   //   - a block pointer
1326   CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1327   CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1328   Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1329   if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1330   if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1331     if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1332       CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1333       CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1334     } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1335       CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1336       CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1337     } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1338       CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1339       CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1340     } else {
1341       return false;
1342     }
1343 
1344     TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1345     if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1346     if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1347       return false;
1348   }
1349 
1350   const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1351   FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1352   if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1353 
1354   FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1355   assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1356   if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1357 
1358   ResultTy = ToType;
1359   return true;
1360 }
1361 
1362 /// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1363 /// vector conversion.
1364 ///
1365 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1366 /// conversion.
1367 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
1368                                QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
1369   // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1370   // conversion.
1371   if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1372     return false;
1373 
1374   // Identical types require no conversions.
1375   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1376     return false;
1377 
1378   // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1379   if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1380     // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1381     // identity conversion.
1382     if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1383       return false;
1384 
1385     // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
1386     if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
1387       ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1388       return true;
1389     }
1390   }
1391 
1392   // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1393   // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1394   // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1395   //   same size
1396   if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1397     if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
1398         S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType)) {
1399       ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1400       return true;
1401     }
1402   }
1403 
1404   return false;
1405 }
1406 
1407 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1408                                 bool InOverloadResolution,
1409                                 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1410                                 bool CStyle);
1411 
1412 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1413 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1414 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1415 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1416 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1417 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1418 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1419 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
1420 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1421                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
1422                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1423                                  bool CStyle,
1424                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1425   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1426 
1427   // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
1428   SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
1429   SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
1430   SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1431   SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
1432 
1433   // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
1434   // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
1435   if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
1436     if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
1437       return false;
1438 
1439     // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
1440   }
1441 
1442   // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1443   // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1444   // (C++ 4p1).
1445 
1446   if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1447     DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1448     if (FunctionDecl *Fn
1449           = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
1450                                                  AccessPair)) {
1451       // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1452       // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1453       FromType = Fn->getType();
1454       SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1455 
1456       // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1457       // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1458       if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1459                       S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1460         QualType resultTy;
1461         // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
1462         if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
1463               S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1464           // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1465           if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1466             return false;
1467       }
1468 
1469       // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1470       // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1471       // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1472       // expression.
1473       CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1474       if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1475         assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1476                "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1477         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1478                == UO_AddrOf &&
1479                "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1480         const Type *ClassType
1481           = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1482         FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
1483       } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1484         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1485                UO_AddrOf &&
1486                "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1487         FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1488       }
1489 
1490       // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
1491       assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1492         FromType,
1493         S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
1494     } else {
1495       return false;
1496     }
1497   }
1498   // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1499   //   A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1500   //   be converted to a prvalue.
1501   bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
1502   if (argIsLValue &&
1503       !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
1504       S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1505     SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
1506 
1507     // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1508     //   ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1509     //   of the type of the lvalue ...
1510     if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1511       FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1512 
1513     // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1514     // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
1515     // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1516     // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
1517     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1518   } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1519     // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
1520     SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
1521 
1522     // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1523     // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1524     // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
1525     FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
1526 
1527     if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
1528       // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4)
1529       SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
1530 
1531       // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1532       // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1533       // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1534       // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
1535       SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1536       SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1537       SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
1538       SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
1539       return true;
1540     }
1541   } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
1542     // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
1543     SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
1544 
1545     // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1546     // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1547     // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
1548     FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1549   } else {
1550     // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
1551     SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
1552   }
1553   SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
1554 
1555   // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1556   // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1557   // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1558   // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
1559   // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1560   // conversion.
1561   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
1562   ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
1563   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
1564     // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1565     // conversion to do.
1566     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1567   } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
1568     // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
1569     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
1570     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1571   } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1572     // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
1573     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
1574     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1575   } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1576     // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
1577     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1578     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1579   } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1580              (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1581               FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1582               FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1583               FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1584               FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1585     // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1586     SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1587     FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
1588   } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1589              ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
1590     // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
1591     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
1592     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1593   } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) {
1594     // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
1595     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1596     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1597   } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1598              (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
1599     // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1600     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1601     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1602   } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
1603     // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1604     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1605     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1606   } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
1607               ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
1608              (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1609               ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
1610     // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
1611     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
1612     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1613   } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1614     SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1615   } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1616              S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1617     SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
1618   } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1619                                    FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1620     // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
1621     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
1622     SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
1623     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1624   } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
1625                                          InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
1626     // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
1627     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
1628   } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
1629     SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1630     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1631   } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1632              S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
1633     // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
1634     SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
1635     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1636   } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1637     // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1638     SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
1639   } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1640                                              InOverloadResolution,
1641                                              SCS, CStyle)) {
1642     SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1643     FromType = ToType;
1644   } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1645                                  CStyle)) {
1646     // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
1647     // appropriately.
1648     return true;
1649   } else if (ToType->isEventT() &&
1650              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1651              (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) {
1652     SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion;
1653     FromType = ToType;
1654   } else {
1655     // No second conversion required.
1656     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1657   }
1658   SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
1659 
1660   QualType CanonFrom;
1661   QualType CanonTo;
1662   // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
1663   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1664   if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1665                                   ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
1666     SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1667     SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1668     FromType = ToType;
1669     CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1670     CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1671   } else {
1672     // No conversion required
1673     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1674 
1675     // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
1676     //   [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1677     //   subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1678     //   a conversion. [...]
1679     CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1680     CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1681     if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
1682                                        == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
1683         CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) {
1684       FromType = ToType;
1685       CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1686     }
1687   }
1688   SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
1689 
1690   // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1691   // this is a bad conversion sequence.
1692   if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
1693     return false;
1694 
1695   return true;
1696 }
1697 
1698 static bool
1699 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1700                                      QualType &ToType,
1701                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
1702                                      StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1703                                      bool CStyle) {
1704 
1705   const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1706   if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1707     return false;
1708   // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1709   RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1710   // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1711   for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) {
1712     if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1713                              CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
1714       ToType = it->getType();
1715       return true;
1716     }
1717   }
1718   return false;
1719 }
1720 
1721 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1722 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1723 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1724 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
1725 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
1726   const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
1727   // All integers are built-in.
1728   if (!To) {
1729     return false;
1730   }
1731 
1732   // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1733   // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1734   // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1735   // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1736   // int (C++ 4.5p1).
1737   if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1738       !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
1739     if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1740         (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1741          // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1742          // less than int to an int.
1743          (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
1744           Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
1745       return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1746     }
1747 
1748     return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1749   }
1750 
1751   // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
1752   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1753   //   fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1754   //   following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1755   //   (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1756   //   unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
1757   //   long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
1758   //   values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
1759   //   type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
1760   //   with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1761   //   long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
1762   //   there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
1763   // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
1764   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
1765   //   can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
1766   //   integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
1767   //   unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
1768   //   converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
1769   if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1770     // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1771     // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1772     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1773       return false;
1774 
1775     // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
1776     // even if that's not the promoted type.
1777     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
1778       QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1779       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
1780              IsIntegralPromotion(From, Underlying, ToType);
1781     }
1782 
1783     // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
1784     if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
1785         !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, 0))
1786       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1787                                 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
1788   }
1789 
1790   // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
1791   //   A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1792   //   to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1793   //   represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
1794   //   long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
1795   //   If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
1796   //   underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
1797   //   or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
1798   //   type.
1799   if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
1800       ToType->isIntegerType()) {
1801     // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1802     // unsigned.
1803     bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
1804     uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
1805 
1806     // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1807     // order. Try each of these types.
1808     QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1809       Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
1810       Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1811       Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
1812     };
1813     for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
1814       uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1815       if (FromSize < ToSize ||
1816           (FromSize == ToSize &&
1817            FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1818         // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1819         // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1820         // promotion.
1821         return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1822       }
1823     }
1824   }
1825 
1826   // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1827   // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1828   // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1829   // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1830   // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1831   // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1832   // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
1833   // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1834   // conversion.
1835   using llvm::APSInt;
1836   if (From)
1837     if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) {
1838       APSInt BitWidth;
1839       if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
1840           MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1841         APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1842         ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
1843 
1844         // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1845         if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1846             (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1847           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1848         }
1849 
1850         // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1851         // that fits into an unsigned int?
1852         if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1853           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1854         }
1855 
1856         return false;
1857       }
1858     }
1859 
1860   // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1861   // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
1862   if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
1863     return true;
1864   }
1865 
1866   return false;
1867 }
1868 
1869 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1870 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1871 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
1872 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
1873   if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1874     if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
1875       /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1876       /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
1877       if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1878           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1879         return true;
1880 
1881       // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1882       //   When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1883       //   double is promoted to long double [...].
1884       if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1885           (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1886            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1887           (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1888         return true;
1889 
1890       // Half can be promoted to float.
1891       if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
1892            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
1893           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1894         return true;
1895     }
1896 
1897   return false;
1898 }
1899 
1900 /// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1901 ///
1902 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1903 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
1904 /// floating-point or integral promotion.
1905 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
1906   const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
1907   if (!FromComplex)
1908     return false;
1909 
1910   const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
1911   if (!ToComplex)
1912     return false;
1913 
1914   return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
1915                                   ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1916     IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1917                         ToComplex->getElementType());
1918 }
1919 
1920 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1921 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1922 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1923 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1924 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
1925 ///
1926 static QualType
1927 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
1928                                    QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
1929                                    ASTContext &Context,
1930                                    bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
1931   assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1932           FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1933          "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
1934 
1935   /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1936   if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
1937     return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1938 
1939   QualType CanonFromPointee
1940     = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
1941   QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
1942   Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
1943 
1944   if (StripObjCLifetime)
1945     Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1946 
1947   // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
1948   if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
1949     // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
1950     if (!ToType.isNull())
1951       return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1952 
1953     // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1954     // already.
1955     if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1956       return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
1957     return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1958   }
1959 
1960   // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
1961   QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1962     = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
1963 
1964   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1965     return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1966   return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1967 }
1968 
1969 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
1970                                                bool InOverloadResolution,
1971                                                ASTContext &Context) {
1972   // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1973   // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1974   if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
1975       Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
1976     return !InOverloadResolution;
1977 
1978   return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1979                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1980                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
1981 }
1982 
1983 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1984 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1985 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1986 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1987 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1988 /// ConvertedType.
1989 ///
1990 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1991 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1992 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1993 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1994 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1995 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
1996 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1997 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1998 /// should result in a warning.
1999 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2000                                bool InOverloadResolution,
2001                                QualType& ConvertedType,
2002                                bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2003   IncompatibleObjC = false;
2004   if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
2005                               IncompatibleObjC))
2006     return true;
2007 
2008   // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
2009   if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
2010       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2011     ConvertedType = ToType;
2012     return true;
2013   }
2014 
2015   // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2016   if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
2017       ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
2018     ConvertedType = ToType;
2019     return true;
2020   }
2021   // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2022   // pointer type.
2023   if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
2024       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2025     ConvertedType = ToType;
2026     return true;
2027   }
2028 
2029   // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2030   // pointer constant.
2031   if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
2032       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2033     ConvertedType = ToType;
2034     return true;
2035   }
2036 
2037   const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
2038   if (!ToTypePtr)
2039     return false;
2040 
2041   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
2042   if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2043     ConvertedType = ToType;
2044     return true;
2045   }
2046 
2047   // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
2048   // , including objective-c pointers.
2049   QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
2050   if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
2051       !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
2052     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2053                                       FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2054                                                        ToPointeeType,
2055                                                        ToType, Context);
2056     return true;
2057   }
2058   const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
2059   if (!FromTypePtr)
2060     return false;
2061 
2062   QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
2063 
2064   // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
2065   // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2066   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2067     return false;
2068 
2069   // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2070   // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2071   // 4.10p2).
2072   if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2073       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2074     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2075                                                        ToPointeeType,
2076                                                        ToType, Context,
2077                                                    /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
2078     return true;
2079   }
2080 
2081   // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
2082   if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
2083       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2084     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2085                                                        ToPointeeType,
2086                                                        ToType, Context);
2087     return true;
2088   }
2089 
2090   // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2091   // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
2092   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2093       Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2094     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2095                                                        ToPointeeType,
2096                                                        ToType, Context);
2097     return true;
2098   }
2099 
2100   // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
2101   //
2102   //   An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2103   //   can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2104   //   B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2105   //   (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2106   //   necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2107   //   conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2108   //   derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2109   //   the null pointer value of the destination type.
2110   //
2111   // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2112   // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
2113   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2114       FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2115       !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
2116       !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, 0) &&
2117       IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2118     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2119                                                        ToPointeeType,
2120                                                        ToType, Context);
2121     return true;
2122   }
2123 
2124   if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2125       Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2126     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2127                                                        ToPointeeType,
2128                                                        ToType, Context);
2129     return true;
2130   }
2131 
2132   return false;
2133 }
2134 
2135 /// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2136 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2137   Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2138 
2139   // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2140   if (TQs == Qs)
2141     return T;
2142 
2143   if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2144     return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2145 
2146   return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2147 }
2148 
2149 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2150 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2151 /// with the same arguments and return values.
2152 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2153                                    QualType& ConvertedType,
2154                                    bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2155   if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
2156     return false;
2157 
2158   // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2159   Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2160 
2161   // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
2162   const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2163     ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2164   const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
2165     FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2166 
2167   if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
2168     // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2169     // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2170     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2171                                        FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2172       return false;
2173 
2174     // Check for compatible
2175     // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
2176     // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
2177     if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2178       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2179       return true;
2180     }
2181     // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
2182     if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
2183          ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
2184         Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
2185                                                   /*compare=*/false)) {
2186       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2187       return true;
2188     }
2189     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
2190     // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
2191     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
2192       const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2193       const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2194       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
2195           !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2196                                                 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2197         return false;
2198       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
2199                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2200                                                          ToType, Context);
2201       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2202       return true;
2203     }
2204 
2205     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2206       // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2207       // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2208       // complain about it.
2209       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2210       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
2211                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2212                                                          ToType, Context);
2213       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2214       return true;
2215     }
2216   }
2217   // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
2218   QualType ToPointeeType;
2219   if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2220     ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
2221   else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2222             ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
2223     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
2224     // to a block pointer type.
2225     if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2226       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2227       return true;
2228     }
2229     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2230   }
2231   else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
2232            ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2233     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
2234     // pointer to any object.
2235     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2236     return true;
2237   }
2238   else
2239     return false;
2240 
2241   QualType FromPointeeType;
2242   if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2243     FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
2244   else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2245            FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2246     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2247   else
2248     return false;
2249 
2250   // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2251   // is an Objective-C conversion.
2252   if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2253       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2254                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
2255     // We always complain about this conversion.
2256     IncompatibleObjC = true;
2257     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
2258     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2259     return true;
2260   }
2261   // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2262   // as in I* to id.
2263   if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2264       ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2265       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2266                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
2267 
2268     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
2269     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2270     return true;
2271   }
2272 
2273   // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
2274   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2275   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2276   // complain about it).
2277   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2278     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2279   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2280     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2281   if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2282     // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2283     // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2284     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2285           == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2286       return false;
2287 
2288     // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2289     // function types are obviously different.
2290     if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
2291         FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2292         FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2293       return false;
2294 
2295     bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2296     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) ==
2297         Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
2298       // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2299     } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2300                                        ToFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2301                                        ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2302       // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2303       HasObjCConversion = true;
2304     } else {
2305       // Function types are too different. Abort.
2306       return false;
2307     }
2308 
2309     // Check argument types.
2310     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
2311          ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2312       QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2313       QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2314       if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2315             == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2316         // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2317       } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2318                                          ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2319         // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2320         HasObjCConversion = true;
2321       } else {
2322         // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2323         return false;
2324       }
2325     }
2326 
2327     if (HasObjCConversion) {
2328       // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2329       // conversion, but complain about it.
2330       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2331       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2332       return true;
2333     }
2334   }
2335 
2336   return false;
2337 }
2338 
2339 /// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2340 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2341 ///
2342 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2343 ///
2344 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2345 ///
2346 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2347 /// this conversion.
2348 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2349                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
2350   if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
2351       Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2352     return false;
2353 
2354   // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2355   QualType ToPointee;
2356   if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2357     ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2358   else
2359     return false;
2360 
2361   Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2362   if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2363       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
2364       !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
2365     return false;
2366 
2367   // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2368   QualType FromPointee;
2369   if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2370     FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2371   else
2372     return false;
2373 
2374   Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2375   if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2376       (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2377        FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2378     return false;
2379 
2380   // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2381   FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2382   if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2383     return false;
2384 
2385   // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2386   // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2387   // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2388   FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2389 
2390   // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2391   ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2392   bool IncompatibleObjC;
2393   if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2394     FromPointee = ToPointee;
2395   else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2396                                     IncompatibleObjC))
2397     return false;
2398 
2399   /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2400   /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2401   FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2402   ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2403   return true;
2404 }
2405 
2406 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2407                                     QualType& ConvertedType) {
2408   QualType ToPointeeType;
2409   if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2410         ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2411     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2412   else
2413     return false;
2414 
2415   QualType FromPointeeType;
2416   if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2417       FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2418     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2419   else
2420     return false;
2421   // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2422   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2423   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2424 
2425   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2426     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2427   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2428     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2429 
2430   if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2431     return false;
2432 
2433   if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2434     return true;
2435 
2436   // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2437   // function types are obviously different.
2438   if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
2439       FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2440     return false;
2441 
2442   FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2443   FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2444   if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2445     return false;
2446 
2447   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
2448   if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2449                           ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
2450     // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2451   } else {
2452     QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType();
2453     QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType();
2454     if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
2455         !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2456        LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2457 
2458      if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2459        // OK exact match.
2460      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2461                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2462      if (IncompatibleObjC)
2463        return false;
2464      // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2465      }
2466      else
2467        return false;
2468    }
2469 
2470    // Check argument types.
2471    for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
2472         ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2473      IncompatibleObjC = false;
2474      QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2475      QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2476      if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2477        // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2478      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2479                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2480        if (IncompatibleObjC)
2481          return false;
2482        // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2483      } else
2484        // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2485        return false;
2486    }
2487    if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2488        !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2489                                                     ToFunctionType))
2490      return false;
2491 
2492    ConvertedType = ToType;
2493    return true;
2494 }
2495 
2496 enum {
2497   ft_default,
2498   ft_different_class,
2499   ft_parameter_arity,
2500   ft_parameter_mismatch,
2501   ft_return_type,
2502   ft_qualifer_mismatch
2503 };
2504 
2505 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2506 /// function types.  Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2507 /// parameter types, and different return types.
2508 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2509                                       QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2510   // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2511   if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2512     PDiag << ft_default;
2513     return;
2514   }
2515 
2516   // Get the function type from the pointers.
2517   if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2518     const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2519                             *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2520     if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) {
2521       PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2522             << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2523       return;
2524     }
2525     FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2526     ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
2527   }
2528 
2529   if (FromType->isPointerType())
2530     FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2531   if (ToType->isPointerType())
2532     ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2533 
2534   // Remove references.
2535   FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2536   ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2537 
2538   // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2539   if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2540       !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2541     PDiag << ft_default;
2542     return;
2543   }
2544 
2545   // No extra info for same types.
2546   if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2547     PDiag << ft_default;
2548     return;
2549   }
2550 
2551   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(),
2552                           *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2553 
2554   // Both types need to be function types.
2555   if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2556     PDiag << ft_default;
2557     return;
2558   }
2559 
2560   if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) {
2561     PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams()
2562           << FromFunction->getNumParams();
2563     return;
2564   }
2565 
2566   // Handle different parameter types.
2567   unsigned ArgPos;
2568   if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2569     PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2570           << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos)
2571           << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos);
2572     return;
2573   }
2574 
2575   // Handle different return type.
2576   if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(),
2577                            ToFunction->getReturnType())) {
2578     PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType()
2579           << FromFunction->getReturnType();
2580     return;
2581   }
2582 
2583   unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2584            ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2585   if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2586     PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2587     return;
2588   }
2589 
2590   // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2591   PDiag << ft_default;
2592 }
2593 
2594 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
2595 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
2596 /// they have same number of arguments.  If the parameters are different,
2597 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter.
2598 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
2599                                       const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2600                                       unsigned *ArgPos) {
2601   for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(),
2602                                               N = NewType->param_type_begin(),
2603                                               E = OldType->param_type_end();
2604        O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2605     if (!Context.hasSameType(O->getUnqualifiedType(),
2606                              N->getUnqualifiedType())) {
2607       if (ArgPos)
2608         *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin();
2609       return false;
2610     }
2611   }
2612   return true;
2613 }
2614 
2615 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2616 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
2617 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
2618 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2619 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2620 /// error, or returns false otherwise.
2621 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2622                                   CastKind &Kind,
2623                                   CXXCastPath& BasePath,
2624                                   bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
2625   QualType FromType = From->getType();
2626   bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
2627 
2628   Kind = CK_BitCast;
2629 
2630   if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
2631       From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
2632       Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2633     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
2634       DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
2635                           PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2636                             << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
2637     else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
2638       Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
2639         << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2640   }
2641   if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2642     if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2643       QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2644                ToPointeeType   = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
2645 
2646       if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2647           !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2648         // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2649         // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
2650         if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2651                                          From->getExprLoc(),
2652                                          From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
2653                                          IgnoreBaseAccess))
2654           return true;
2655 
2656         // The conversion was successful.
2657         Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
2658       }
2659     }
2660   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2661                ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2662     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2663           FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2664       // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2665       // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2666       // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
2667       if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
2668         return false;
2669     } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2670       Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2671     } else {
2672       Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2673     }
2674   } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2675     if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2676       Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
2677   }
2678 
2679   // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2680   // reasons.
2681   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2682     Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2683 
2684   return false;
2685 }
2686 
2687 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2688 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2689 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2690 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2691 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2692 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
2693                                      QualType ToType,
2694                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
2695                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
2696   const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2697   if (!ToTypePtr)
2698     return false;
2699 
2700   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
2701   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2702                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2703                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
2704     ConvertedType = ToType;
2705     return true;
2706   }
2707 
2708   // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
2709   const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2710   if (!FromTypePtr)
2711     return false;
2712 
2713   // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2714   // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2715   QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2716   QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2717 
2718   if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
2719       !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, 0) &&
2720       IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
2721     ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2722                                                  ToClass.getTypePtr());
2723     return true;
2724   }
2725 
2726   return false;
2727 }
2728 
2729 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2730 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
2731 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
2732 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2733 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2734 /// otherwise.
2735 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2736                                         CastKind &Kind,
2737                                         CXXCastPath &BasePath,
2738                                         bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
2739   QualType FromType = From->getType();
2740   const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2741   if (!FromPtrType) {
2742     // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
2743     assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2744                                        Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
2745            "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
2746     Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
2747     return false;
2748   }
2749 
2750   const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2751   assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2752                       "that is not a member pointer.");
2753 
2754   QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2755   QualType ToClass   = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2756 
2757   // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2758   assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2759   assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2760 
2761   CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
2762                      /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
2763   bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2764   assert(DerivationOkay &&
2765          "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2766   (void)DerivationOkay;
2767 
2768   if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2769                                   getUnqualifiedType())) {
2770     std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2771     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2772       << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2773     return true;
2774   }
2775 
2776   if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
2777     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2778       << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2779       << From->getSourceRange();
2780     return true;
2781   }
2782 
2783   if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
2784     CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2785                          Paths.front(),
2786                          diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
2787 
2788   // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
2789   BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
2790   Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
2791   return false;
2792 }
2793 
2794 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given
2795 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial.
2796 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals,
2797                                                Qualifiers ToQuals) {
2798   // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial.
2799   if (ToQuals.hasConst() &&
2800       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone)
2801     return false;
2802 
2803   return true;
2804 }
2805 
2806 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2807 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2808 /// (C++ 4.4).
2809 ///
2810 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2811 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2812 /// object lifetime.
2813 bool
2814 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2815                                 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
2816   FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2817   ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
2818   ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2819 
2820   // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2821   // qualification conversion.
2822   if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
2823     return false;
2824 
2825   // (C++ 4.4p4):
2826   //   A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2827   //   in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2828   bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
2829   bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
2830   while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
2831     // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2832     // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2833     // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
2834     // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
2835     // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2836     // unwrap.
2837     UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
2838 
2839     Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2840     Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2841 
2842     // Objective-C ARC:
2843     //   Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2844     if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2845         UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2846       if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2847         if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals))
2848           ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2849         FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2850         ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2851       } else {
2852         // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2853         // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2854         return false;
2855       }
2856     }
2857 
2858     // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2859     if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2860         (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2861       FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2862       ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2863     }
2864 
2865     //   -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2866     //      2,j, and similarly for volatile.
2867     if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2868       return false;
2869 
2870     //   -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2871     //      every cv for 0 < k < j.
2872     if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
2873         && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
2874       return false;
2875 
2876     // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2877     // include const.
2878     PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
2879       = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
2880   }
2881 
2882   // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2883   // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2884   // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2885   // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2886   // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
2887   return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
2888 }
2889 
2890 /// \brief - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
2891 /// atomic type.
2892 ///
2893 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
2894 /// sequence to finish the conversion.
2895 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2896                                 bool InOverloadResolution,
2897                                 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2898                                 bool CStyle) {
2899   const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
2900   if (!ToAtomic)
2901     return false;
2902 
2903   StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
2904   if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
2905                             InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
2906                             CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
2907     return false;
2908 
2909   SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
2910   SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
2911   SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
2912   SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
2913     = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
2914   SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
2915   return true;
2916 }
2917 
2918 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
2919                                               CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
2920                                               QualType Type) {
2921   const FunctionProtoType *CtorType =
2922       Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2923   if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) {
2924     QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0);
2925     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
2926       return true;
2927   }
2928   return false;
2929 }
2930 
2931 static OverloadingResult
2932 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2933                                        CXXRecordDecl *To,
2934                                        UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2935                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
2936                                        bool AllowExplicit) {
2937   DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(To);
2938   for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
2939        Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
2940     NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2941     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2942 
2943     // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2944     CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = nullptr;
2945     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
2946       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2947     if (ConstructorTmpl)
2948       Constructor
2949         = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2950     else
2951       Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
2952 
2953     bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
2954                   S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) &&
2955                   (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2956     if (Usable) {
2957       // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
2958       // suppress conversions.
2959       bool SuppressUserConversions =
2960           isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
2961       if (ConstructorTmpl)
2962         S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2963                                        /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr,
2964                                        From, CandidateSet,
2965                                        SuppressUserConversions);
2966       else
2967         S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
2968                                From, CandidateSet,
2969                                SuppressUserConversions);
2970     }
2971   }
2972 
2973   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2974 
2975   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2976   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
2977   case OR_Success: {
2978     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2979     CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
2980     QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2981     // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
2982     User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
2983     User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
2984     User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
2985     User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
2986     User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2987     User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2988     User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2989     return OR_Success;
2990   }
2991 
2992   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2993     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2994   case OR_Deleted:
2995     return OR_Deleted;
2996   case OR_Ambiguous:
2997     return OR_Ambiguous;
2998   }
2999 
3000   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3001 }
3002 
3003 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
3004 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
3005 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
3006 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
3007 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
3008 /// false and User is unspecified.
3009 ///
3010 /// \param AllowExplicit  true if the conversion should consider C++0x
3011 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
3012 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
3013 ///
3014 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should
3015 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit
3016 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set.
3017 static OverloadingResult
3018 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3019                         UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3020                         OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
3021                         bool AllowExplicit,
3022                         bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
3023   assert(AllowExplicit || !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
3024 
3025   // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3026   bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3027 
3028   // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3029   // constructors.
3030   if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3031     // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3032     //   When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3033     //   copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3034     //   derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3035     //   constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3036     //   functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3037     //   that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3038     //   the parentheses of the initializer.
3039     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
3040         (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
3041          S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
3042       ConstructorsOnly = true;
3043 
3044     S.RequireCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType, 0);
3045     // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
3046     // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
3047     // to try to recover.
3048     if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
3049       // We're not going to find any constructors.
3050     } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3051                  = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
3052 
3053       Expr **Args = &From;
3054       unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3055       bool ListInitializing = false;
3056       if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3057         // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work.
3058         OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3059             S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit);
3060         if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3061           return Result;
3062         // Never mind.
3063         CandidateSet.clear();
3064 
3065         // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3066         // arguments, not the entire list.
3067         Args = InitList->getInits();
3068         NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3069         ListInitializing = true;
3070       }
3071 
3072       DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
3073       for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
3074            Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
3075         NamedDecl *D = *Con;
3076         DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
3077 
3078         // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
3079         CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = nullptr;
3080         FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
3081           = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
3082         if (ConstructorTmpl)
3083           Constructor
3084             = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
3085         else
3086           Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
3087 
3088         bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3089         if (ListInitializing)
3090           Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
3091         else
3092           Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
3093         if (Usable) {
3094           bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3095           if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3096             SuppressUserConversions = false;
3097             if (NumArgs == 1) {
3098               // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3099               // suppress conversions.
3100               SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3101                                                 S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
3102             }
3103           }
3104           if (ConstructorTmpl)
3105             S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
3106                                            /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr,
3107                                            llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
3108                                            CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3109           else
3110             // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3111             // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
3112             S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
3113                                    llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
3114                                    CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3115         }
3116       }
3117     }
3118   }
3119 
3120   // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
3121   if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3122   } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 0)) {
3123     // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
3124   } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
3125                                    = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3126     if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
3127          = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3128       // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
3129       std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
3130                 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
3131         Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3132       for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
3133              I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
3134         DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3135         NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
3136         CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3137         if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3138           D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3139 
3140         CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3141         FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
3142         if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3143           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3144         else
3145           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3146 
3147         if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
3148           if (ConvTemplate)
3149             S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
3150                                              ActingContext, From, ToType,
3151                                              CandidateSet,
3152                                              AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
3153           else
3154             S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
3155                                      From, ToType, CandidateSet,
3156                                      AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
3157         }
3158       }
3159     }
3160   }
3161 
3162   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3163 
3164   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
3165   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
3166   case OR_Success:
3167     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3168     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3169           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3170       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3171       //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3172       //   constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3173       //   sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3174       //   the argument of the constructor.
3175       //
3176       QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
3177       if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3178         // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3179         User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3180       } else {
3181         if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3182           User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3183         else {
3184           User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3185           User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3186         }
3187       }
3188       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3189       User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
3190       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3191       User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3192       User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3193       User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3194       return OR_Success;
3195     }
3196     if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3197                  = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3198       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3199       //
3200       //   [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3201       //   conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3202       //   conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3203       //   implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3204       User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3205       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3206       User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
3207       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3208       User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3209 
3210       // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3211       //   The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3212       //   result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3213       //   for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3214       //   is an initialization, the special rules for
3215       //   initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3216       //   selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3217       //   user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3218       //   13.3.3.1).
3219       User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3220       return OR_Success;
3221     }
3222     llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
3223 
3224   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3225     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3226   case OR_Deleted:
3227     // No conversion here! We're done.
3228     return OR_Deleted;
3229 
3230   case OR_Ambiguous:
3231     return OR_Ambiguous;
3232   }
3233 
3234   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3235 }
3236 
3237 bool
3238 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
3239   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3240   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(),
3241                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
3242   OverloadingResult OvResult =
3243     IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
3244                             CandidateSet, false, false);
3245   if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
3246     Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3247         << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3248   else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()) {
3249     if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType,
3250                              diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete,
3251                              From->getType(), From->getSourceRange()))
3252       Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3253           << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType;
3254   } else
3255     return false;
3256   CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From);
3257   return true;
3258 }
3259 
3260 /// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3261 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3262 /// is possible.
3263 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3264 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1,
3265                            FunctionDecl *Function2) {
3266   if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
3267     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3268 
3269   // Objective-C++:
3270   //   If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3271   //   a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3272   //   respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3273   //   because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3274   //   to keep code working.
3275   CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3276   if (!Conv1)
3277     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3278 
3279   CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3280   if (!Conv2)
3281     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3282 
3283   if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) {
3284     bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3285     bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3286     if (Block1 != Block2)
3287       return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3288                     : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3289   }
3290 
3291   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3292 }
3293 
3294 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(
3295     const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) {
3296   return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) ||
3297          (ICS.isUserDefined() &&
3298           ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr);
3299 }
3300 
3301 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3302 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3303 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
3304 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3305 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3306                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3307                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
3308 {
3309   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3310   // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3311   //   -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3312   //      conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3313   //      an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3314   //   -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3315   //      conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3316   //      (13.3.3.1.3).
3317   //
3318   // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3319   //   For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3320   //   described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3321   //   treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3322   //   from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
3323 
3324   // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has
3325   // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at
3326   // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse
3327   // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the
3328   // standard. For example:
3329   //
3330   // int &f(...);    // #1
3331   // void f(char*);  // #2
3332   // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); }
3333   //
3334   // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function.
3335   // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis
3336   // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there
3337   // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't
3338   // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11.
3339   // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued
3340   // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11.
3341 
3342   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings &&
3343       hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) !=
3344       hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2))
3345     return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1)
3346                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3347                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3348 
3349   if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3350     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3351   if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
3352     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3353 
3354   // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3355   // the same kind.
3356   if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3357     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3358 
3359   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3360       ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3361 
3362   // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3363   // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3364   // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3365   if (ICS1.isStandard())
3366     Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3367                                                 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
3368   else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
3369     // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3370     // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3371     // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3372     // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3373     // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3374     // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
3375     if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
3376           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
3377       Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3378                                                   ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3379                                                   ICS2.UserDefined.After);
3380     else
3381       Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3382                                           ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3383                                           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
3384   }
3385 
3386   // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3387   // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X>
3388   // for some X and L2 does not.
3389   if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable &&
3390       !ICS1.isBad()) {
3391     if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3392         !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3393       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3394     if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3395         ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3396       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3397   }
3398 
3399   return Result;
3400 }
3401 
3402 static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3403   while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3404     Qualifiers Quals;
3405     T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
3406     T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
3407   }
3408 
3409   return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3410 }
3411 
3412 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3413 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3414 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3415 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3416                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3417                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3418   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3419     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3420 
3421   // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
3422   // any non-identity conversion sequence
3423   if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3424     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3425   else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3426     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3427 
3428   if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3429     if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3430       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3431     else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3432       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3433     else
3434       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3435   } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
3436     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3437 
3438   if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3439     return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3440                              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3441   }
3442 
3443   if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3444     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3445              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3446              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3447 
3448   if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3449     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3450              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3451              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3452 
3453   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3454 }
3455 
3456 /// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3457 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3458 static bool
3459 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3460                              const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3461   // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3462   //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3463   //      implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
3464   //      without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
3465   //      to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
3466   //      lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
3467   //      reference*.
3468   //
3469   // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3470   // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3471   // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3472   // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3473   // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
3474   if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3475       SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3476     return false;
3477 
3478   return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3479           SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3480          (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3481           !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue);
3482 }
3483 
3484 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3485 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3486 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
3487 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3488 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3489                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3490                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
3491 {
3492   // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3493   // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3494 
3495   //  -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3496   //     sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3497   //     excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3498   //     sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3499   //     non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
3500   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
3501         = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
3502     return CK;
3503 
3504   //  -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3505   //     defined below), or, if not that,
3506   ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3507   ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3508   if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3509     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3510   else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3511     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3512 
3513   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3514   // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3515   // applies:
3516 
3517   //   A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3518   //   pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3519   //   that is such a conversion.
3520   if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3521     return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3522              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3523              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3524 
3525   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3526   //
3527   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
3528   //   conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3529   //   void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3530   //   of B* to void*.
3531   bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
3532     = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
3533   bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
3534     = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
3535   if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3536     // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3537     // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
3538     return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3539                               : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3540   } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3541     // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3542     // their derived-to-base conversions.
3543     if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
3544           = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
3545       return DerivedCK;
3546   } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3547              !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
3548     // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3549     // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3550     // inheritance relationship in their sources.
3551     QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3552     QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
3553 
3554     // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3555     // conversion, if we need to.
3556     if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
3557       FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
3558     if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
3559       FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
3560 
3561     QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3562     QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3563 
3564     if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
3565       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3566     else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
3567       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3568 
3569     // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3570     // other, it is the better one.
3571     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3572       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3573     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3574       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3575     if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3576       bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3577                                                           FromObjCPtr2);
3578       bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3579                                                            FromObjCPtr1);
3580       if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3581         return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3582                          : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3583       }
3584     }
3585   }
3586 
3587   // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3588   // bullet 3).
3589   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
3590         = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
3591     return QualCK;
3592 
3593   if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
3594     // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3595     if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3596       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3597     else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3598       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3599 
3600     // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3601     //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3602     //      which the references refer are the same type except for
3603     //      top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3604     //      initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3605     //      to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
3606     QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3607     QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
3608     T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3609     T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
3610     Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3611     QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3612     QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3613     if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3614       // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3615       // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3616       if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3617                                           SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3618         return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3619                                            ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3620                                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3621       }
3622 
3623       // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3624       // type for comparison.
3625       if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3626         T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3627       if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3628         T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3629       if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3630         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3631       else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
3632         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3633     }
3634   }
3635 
3636   // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3637   // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3638   // is between types of the same size.
3639   // For example:
3640   // void f(float);
3641   // void f(int);
3642   // int main {
3643   //    long a;
3644   //    f(a);
3645   // }
3646   // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3647   // as clang will do in standard mode.
3648   if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3649       SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
3650       S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
3651           S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
3652     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3653 
3654   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3655 }
3656 
3657 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3658 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
3659 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3660 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3661 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3662                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3663                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3664   // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
3665   //  -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3666   //     yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3667   //     cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3668   //     the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3669   //     deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3670   if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3671       SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3672     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3673 
3674   // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3675   // conversion (!)
3676   QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3677   QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
3678   T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3679   T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
3680   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3681   QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3682   QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3683 
3684   // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3685   // them.
3686   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
3687     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3688 
3689   // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3690   // for comparison.
3691   if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3692     T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3693   if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3694     T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3695 
3696   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3697     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3698 
3699   // Objective-C++ ARC:
3700   //   Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3701   //   to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3702   if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3703                                       SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3704     Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3705                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3706                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3707   }
3708 
3709   while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3710     // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3711     // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3712     // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
3713     // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
3714     // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3715     // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3716     // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3717     // strict subset of qualifiers.
3718     if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3719       // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3720       // about how the sequences rank.
3721       ;
3722     else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3723       // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3724       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3725         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3726         // qualifiers.
3727         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3728 
3729       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3730     } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3731       // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3732       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3733         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3734         // qualifiers.
3735         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3736 
3737       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3738     } else {
3739       // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3740       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3741     }
3742 
3743     // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
3744     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
3745       break;
3746   }
3747 
3748   // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3749   // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3750   switch (Result) {
3751   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
3752     if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
3753       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3754     break;
3755 
3756   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3757     break;
3758 
3759   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
3760     if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
3761       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3762     break;
3763   }
3764 
3765   return Result;
3766 }
3767 
3768 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3769 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
3770 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3771 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3).  As part of these checks, we also look at
3772 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
3773 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3774 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3775                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3776                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3777   QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3778   QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
3779   QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
3780   QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
3781 
3782   // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3783   // conversion, if we need to.
3784   if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
3785     FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
3786   if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
3787     FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
3788 
3789   // Canonicalize all of the types.
3790   FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3791   ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3792   FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3793   ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
3794 
3795   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
3796   //
3797   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3798   //   class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
3799   //
3800   // Compare based on pointer conversions.
3801   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3802       SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3803       /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3804       FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3805       ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
3806     QualType FromPointee1
3807       = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3808     QualType ToPointee1
3809       = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3810     QualType FromPointee2
3811       = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3812     QualType ToPointee2
3813       = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3814 
3815     //   -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3816     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
3817       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
3818         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3819       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
3820         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3821     }
3822 
3823     //   -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3824     if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
3825       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
3826         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3827       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
3828         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3829     }
3830   } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3831              SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3832     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3833       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3834     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3835       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3836     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3837       = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3838     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3839       = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3840 
3841     if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3842       // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3843       // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3844       // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3845       // Objective-C pointer types.
3846       bool FromAssignLeft
3847         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3848       bool FromAssignRight
3849         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3850       bool ToAssignLeft
3851         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3852       bool ToAssignRight
3853         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3854 
3855       // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3856       // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3857       if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3858           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3859         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3860       if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3861           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3862         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3863 
3864       // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3865       // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3866       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3867         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3868       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3869         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3870 
3871       // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3872       // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3873       if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3874           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3875         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3876       if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3877           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3878         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3879 
3880       // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3881       // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3882       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3883         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3884       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3885         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3886 
3887       //   -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3888       if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3889           !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3890           (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3891         return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3892                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3893 
3894       //   -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3895       if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3896           (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3897         return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3898         : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3899     }
3900   }
3901 
3902   // Ranking of member-pointer types.
3903   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3904       FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3905       ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
3906     const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
3907                                         FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3908     const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
3909                                           ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3910     const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
3911                                           FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3912     const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
3913                                           ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3914     const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3915     const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3916     const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3917     const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3918     QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3919     QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3920     QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3921     QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3922     // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
3923     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
3924       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
3925         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3926       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
3927         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3928     }
3929     // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3930     if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
3931       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
3932         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3933       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
3934         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3935     }
3936   }
3937 
3938   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
3939     //   -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
3940     //   -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3941     //      B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3942     //      reference of type A&,
3943     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3944         !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3945       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
3946         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3947       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
3948         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3949     }
3950 
3951     //   -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
3952     //   -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3953     //      A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3954     //      reference of type A&,
3955     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3956         S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3957       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
3958         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3959       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
3960         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3961     }
3962   }
3963 
3964   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3965 }
3966 
3967 /// \brief Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid
3968 /// C++ class.
3969 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) {
3970   if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3971     return !Record->isInvalidDecl();
3972 
3973   return true;
3974 }
3975 
3976 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3977 /// determine whether they are reference-related,
3978 /// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3979 /// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3980 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3981 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3982 /// type being initialized.
3983 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3984 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3985                                    QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
3986                                    bool &DerivedToBase,
3987                                    bool &ObjCConversion,
3988                                    bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
3989   assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3990     "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3991   assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3992 
3993   QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3994   QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3995   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3996   QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3997   QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3998 
3999   // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4000   //   Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
4001   //   reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
4002   //   T1 is a base class of T2.
4003   DerivedToBase = false;
4004   ObjCConversion = false;
4005   ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
4006   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
4007     // Nothing to do.
4008   } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, 0) &&
4009              isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) &&
4010              IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
4011     DerivedToBase = true;
4012   else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4013            UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4014            Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
4015     ObjCConversion = true;
4016   else
4017     return Ref_Incompatible;
4018 
4019   // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
4020   // least).
4021 
4022   // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
4023   // for comparison.
4024   if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
4025     T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
4026   if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
4027     T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
4028 
4029   // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4030   //   "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
4031   //   reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
4032   //   as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
4033   //   overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
4034   //   cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
4035   //   reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
4036   //
4037   // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
4038   // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
4039   // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
4040   // space 2.
4041   if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
4042       T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
4043     if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(T2Quals, T1Quals))
4044       ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
4045 
4046     T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4047     T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4048   }
4049 
4050   if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
4051     return Ref_Compatible;
4052   else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4053     return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
4054   else
4055     return Ref_Related;
4056 }
4057 
4058 /// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
4059 ///        with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4060 static bool
4061 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4062                          QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4063                          Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4064                          bool AllowExplicit) {
4065   assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4066   CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
4067     = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4068 
4069   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
4070   std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
4071             CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
4072     Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4073   for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
4074          I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
4075     NamedDecl *D = *I;
4076     CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4077     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4078       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4079 
4080     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4081       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4082     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4083     if (ConvTemplate)
4084       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4085     else
4086       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4087 
4088     // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
4089     // explicit conversions, skip it.
4090     if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
4091       continue;
4092 
4093     if (AllowRvalues) {
4094       bool DerivedToBase = false;
4095       bool ObjCConversion = false;
4096       bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
4097 
4098       // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4099       // functions that return lvalues.
4100       if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4101         const ReferenceType *RefType
4102           = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4103         if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4104           continue;
4105       }
4106 
4107       if (!ConvTemplate &&
4108           S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4109             DeclLoc,
4110             Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4111               .getUnqualifiedType(),
4112             DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
4113             DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
4114           Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
4115         continue;
4116     } else {
4117       // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4118       // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4119       // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4120 
4121       const ReferenceType *RefType =
4122         Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4123       if (!RefType ||
4124           (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4125            !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4126         continue;
4127     }
4128 
4129     if (ConvTemplate)
4130       S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
4131                                        Init, DeclType, CandidateSet,
4132                                        /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4133     else
4134       S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
4135                                DeclType, CandidateSet,
4136                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4137   }
4138 
4139   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4140 
4141   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
4142   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
4143   case OR_Success:
4144     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4145     //
4146     //   [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4147     //   applying a conversion function to the argument
4148     //   expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4149     //   user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4150     //   second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4151     //   conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4152     //   entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4153     //   type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4154     if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4155       return false;
4156 
4157     ICS.setUserDefined();
4158     ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4159     ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
4160     ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
4161     ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
4162     ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
4163     ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4164     assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4165            ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4166            "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4167     return true;
4168 
4169   case OR_Ambiguous:
4170     ICS.setAmbiguous();
4171     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4172          Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4173       if (Cand->Viable)
4174         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
4175     return true;
4176 
4177   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4178   case OR_Deleted:
4179     // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4180     // conversion; continue with other checks.
4181     return false;
4182   }
4183 
4184   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
4185 }
4186 
4187 /// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4188 /// initialization.
4189 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4190 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
4191                  SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4192                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
4193                  bool AllowExplicit) {
4194   assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4195 
4196   // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4197   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4198   ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4199 
4200   QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4201   QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4202 
4203   // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4204   // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4205   // type of the resulting function.
4206   if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4207     DeclAccessPair Found;
4208     if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4209                                                                 false, Found))
4210       T2 = Fn->getType();
4211   }
4212 
4213   // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4214   bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4215   bool DerivedToBase = false;
4216   bool ObjCConversion = false;
4217   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
4218   Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
4219   Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4220     = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
4221                                      ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
4222 
4223 
4224   // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
4225   //   A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4226   //   of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4227 
4228   //     -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
4229   if (!isRValRef) {
4230     //     -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4231     //        reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4232     //
4233     // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4234     if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
4235         RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
4236       // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4237       //   When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4238       //   to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4239       //   is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4240       //   has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4241       //   in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4242       //   derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4243       ICS.setStandard();
4244       ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
4245       ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4246                          : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4247                          : ICK_Identity;
4248       ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4249       ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4250       ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4251       ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4252       ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4253       ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4254       ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
4255       ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4256       ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4257       ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
4258       ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4259       ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
4260       ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
4261       ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
4262 
4263       // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4264       // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4265       // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4266       // [over.best.ics]p2).
4267       return ICS;
4268     }
4269 
4270     //       -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4271     //          not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4272     //          converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4273     //          is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4274     //          conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4275     //          conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4276     //          one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4277     if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
4278         !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
4279         RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
4280       if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4281                                    Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4282                                    AllowExplicit))
4283         return ICS;
4284     }
4285   }
4286 
4287   //     -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4288   //        non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
4289   //        shall be an rvalue reference.
4290   //
4291   // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
4292   // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
4293   // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
4294   // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
4295   // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
4296   // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
4297   // qualifier.
4298   // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
4299   // go together.
4300   if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified()))
4301     return ICS;
4302 
4303   //       -- If the initializer expression
4304   //
4305   //            -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
4306   //               lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
4307   if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
4308       (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4309       (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4310       (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4311     ICS.setStandard();
4312     ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
4313     ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4314                       : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4315                       : ICK_Identity;
4316     ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4317     ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4318     ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4319     ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4320     ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4321     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4322     // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4323     // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4324     // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4325     // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4326     // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
4327     ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
4328       S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
4329       !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType());
4330     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4331     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4332     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
4333     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4334     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
4335     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
4336     ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
4337     return ICS;
4338   }
4339 
4340   //            -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4341   //               reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
4342   //               an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4343   //               "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
4344   //               "cv3 T3",
4345   //
4346   //          then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
4347   //          expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
4348   //          in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
4349   //          class subobject).
4350   if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4351       T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
4352       FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4353                                Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4354                                AllowExplicit)) {
4355     // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4356     // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4357     // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4358     // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
4359     if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
4360         ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4361       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4362 
4363     return ICS;
4364   }
4365 
4366   // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try.
4367   if (T1->isFunctionType())
4368     return ICS;
4369 
4370   //       -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4371   //          initialized from the initializer expression using the
4372   //          rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4373   //          reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4374   //          reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4375   //          cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4376   //          cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4377   if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4378     // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4379     // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4380     // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4381     // initialization fails.
4382     //
4383     // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4384     // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
4385     Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4386     Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4387     T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4388     T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4389     T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4390     T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4391     if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4392       return ICS;
4393   }
4394 
4395   // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4396   // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4397   // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4398   // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4399   // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4400   if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4401       (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4402     return ICS;
4403 
4404   // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4405   // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4406   if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4407       isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4408     return ICS;
4409 
4410   // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
4411   //   When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4412   //   an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4413   //   required to convert the argument expression to the
4414   //   underlying type of the reference according to
4415   //   13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4416   //   to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4417   //   the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4418   //   cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4419   //   and does not constitute a conversion.
4420   ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4421                               /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4422                               /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4423                               /*CStyle=*/false,
4424                               /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4425                               /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4426 
4427   // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4428   if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4429     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4430     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4431     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4432     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
4433     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4434     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4435   } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
4436     const ReferenceType *LValRefType =
4437         ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType()
4438             ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4439 
4440     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3:
4441     //   Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a
4442     //   standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...]
4443     //   binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function
4444     //   lvalue.
4445     // Note that the function case is not possible here.
4446     if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType() && LValRefType) {
4447       // FIXME: This is the wrong BadConversionSequence. The problem is binding
4448       // an rvalue reference to a (non-function) lvalue, not binding an lvalue
4449       // reference to an rvalue!
4450       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType);
4451       return ICS;
4452     }
4453 
4454     ICS.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4455     ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
4456     ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4457     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4458     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType;
4459     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4460     ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4461   }
4462 
4463   return ICS;
4464 }
4465 
4466 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4467 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4468                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
4469                       bool InOverloadResolution,
4470                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4471                       bool AllowExplicit = false);
4472 
4473 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4474 /// initializer list From.
4475 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4476 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4477                   bool SuppressUserConversions,
4478                   bool InOverloadResolution,
4479                   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4480   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4481   //   When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4482   //   special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4483 
4484   ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4485   Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
4486 
4487   // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
4488   // initialized from init lists.
4489   if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0))
4490     return Result;
4491 
4492   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4493   //   If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4494   //   all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4495   //   conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4496   //   element of the list to X.
4497   bool toStdInitializerList = false;
4498   QualType X;
4499   if (ToType->isArrayType())
4500     X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
4501   else
4502     toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
4503   if (!X.isNull()) {
4504     for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4505       Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4506       ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4507           TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4508                                 InOverloadResolution,
4509                                 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4510       // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4511       if (ICS.isBad()) {
4512         Result = ICS;
4513         break;
4514       }
4515       // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4516       if (Result.isBad() ||
4517           CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) ==
4518               ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4519         Result = ICS;
4520     }
4521 
4522     // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
4523     // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
4524     if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
4525       Result.setStandard();
4526       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4527       Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4528       Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4529     }
4530 
4531     Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
4532     return Result;
4533   }
4534 
4535   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4536   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4537   //   resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4538   //   conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4539   //   constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4540   //   implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
4541   if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4542     // This function can deal with initializer lists.
4543     return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4544                                     /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4545                                     InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
4546                                     AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4547                                     /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4548   }
4549 
4550   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4551   //   Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4552   //   initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4553   //   sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
4554   if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4555     // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4556     // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4557     // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4558     InitializedEntity Entity =
4559         InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4560                                                /*Consumed=*/false);
4561     if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) {
4562       Result.setUserDefined();
4563       Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4564       // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4565       Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4566       Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4567 
4568       Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4569       Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4570       Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4571       Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr;
4572     }
4573     return Result;
4574   }
4575 
4576   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4577   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
4578   if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4579     // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4580     // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4581     // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4582 
4583     QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4584 
4585     // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4586     // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4587     if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4588       Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4589 
4590       QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4591 
4592       // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4593       // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4594       // type of the resulting function.
4595       if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4596         DeclAccessPair Found;
4597         if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4598                                    Init, ToType, false, Found))
4599           T2 = Fn->getType();
4600       }
4601 
4602       // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4603       bool dummy1 = false;
4604       bool dummy2 = false;
4605       bool dummy3 = false;
4606       Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4607         = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4608                                          dummy2, dummy3);
4609 
4610       if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) {
4611         return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/From->getLocStart(),
4612                                 SuppressUserConversions,
4613                                 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
4614       }
4615     }
4616 
4617     // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4618     // initializer list.
4619     Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4620                                InOverloadResolution,
4621                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4622     if (Result.isFailure())
4623       return Result;
4624     assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4625            "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4626 
4627     // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4628     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4629         (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4630       StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4631                                             Result.UserDefined.After;
4632       SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4633       SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4634       SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4635       SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4636       SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4637       SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4638     } else
4639       Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4640                     From, ToType);
4641     return Result;
4642   }
4643 
4644   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4645   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4646   if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4647     //    - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion
4648     //      sequence is the one required to convert the element to the
4649     //      parameter type.
4650     unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4651     if (NumInits == 1)
4652       Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4653                                      SuppressUserConversions,
4654                                      InOverloadResolution,
4655                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4656     //    - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4657     //      sequence is the identity conversion.
4658     else if (NumInits == 0) {
4659       Result.setStandard();
4660       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4661       Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4662       Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4663     }
4664     return Result;
4665   }
4666 
4667   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4668   //   In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4669   return Result;
4670 }
4671 
4672 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4673 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4674 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4675 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
4676 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
4677 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
4678 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4679 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4680                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
4681                       bool InOverloadResolution,
4682                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4683                       bool AllowExplicit) {
4684   if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4685     return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4686                              InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4687 
4688   if (ToType->isReferenceType())
4689     return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
4690                             /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4691                             SuppressUserConversions,
4692                             AllowExplicit);
4693 
4694   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4695                                SuppressUserConversions,
4696                                /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4697                                InOverloadResolution,
4698                                /*CStyle=*/false,
4699                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4700                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4701 }
4702 
4703 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
4704                                   const CanQualType ToQTy,
4705                                   Sema &S,
4706                                   SourceLocation Loc,
4707                                   ExprValueKind FromVK) {
4708   OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
4709   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4710     TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
4711 
4712   return !ICS.isBad();
4713 }
4714 
4715 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
4716 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
4717 /// expression @p From.
4718 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4719 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
4720                                 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
4721                                 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
4722                                 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
4723   QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
4724   // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
4725   //                 const volatile object.
4726   unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
4727     Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
4728   QualType ImplicitParamType =  S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
4729 
4730   // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
4731   // to exit early.
4732   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4733 
4734   // We need to have an object of class type.
4735   if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
4736     FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
4737 
4738     // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
4739     // better have an lvalue.
4740     assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
4741   }
4742 
4743   assert(FromType->isRecordType());
4744 
4745   // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
4746   //   For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
4747   //   parameter is
4748   //
4749   //     - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
4750   //        ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
4751   //     - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
4752   //        ref-qualifier
4753   //
4754   // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
4755   // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
4756   //
4757   // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
4758   // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
4759   // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
4760   // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
4761   // non-constant references.
4762 
4763   // First check the qualifiers.
4764   QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
4765   if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
4766                                     != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
4767       !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
4768     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
4769                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
4770     return ICS;
4771   }
4772 
4773   // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
4774   // affects the conversion rank.
4775   QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
4776   ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
4777   if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
4778     SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
4779   } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
4780     SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
4781   else {
4782     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
4783                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
4784     return ICS;
4785   }
4786 
4787   // Check the ref-qualifier.
4788   switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
4789   case RQ_None:
4790     // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
4791     break;
4792 
4793   case RQ_LValue:
4794     if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
4795       // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
4796       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
4797                  ImplicitParamType);
4798       return ICS;
4799     }
4800     break;
4801 
4802   case RQ_RValue:
4803     if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
4804       // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
4805       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
4806                  ImplicitParamType);
4807       return ICS;
4808     }
4809     break;
4810   }
4811 
4812   // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
4813   ICS.setStandard();
4814   ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4815   ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
4816   ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
4817   ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
4818   ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4819   ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
4820   ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
4821   ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4822   ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4823   ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4824     = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
4825   return ICS;
4826 }
4827 
4828 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4829 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4830 /// expression.
4831 ExprResult
4832 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
4833                                           NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
4834                                           NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
4835                                           CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
4836   QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
4837   QualType ImplicitParamRecordType  =
4838     Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4839 
4840   Expr::Classification FromClassification;
4841   if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
4842     FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4843     DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
4844     FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
4845   } else {
4846     FromRecordType = From->getType();
4847     DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
4848     FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
4849   }
4850 
4851   // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4852   // the actual argument initialization.
4853   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
4854     = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
4855                                       Method, Method->getParent());
4856   if (ICS.isBad()) {
4857     if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4858       Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4859       Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4860       unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4861       if (CVR) {
4862         Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4863              diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4864           << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4865           << From->getSourceRange();
4866         Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4867           << Method->getDeclName();
4868         return ExprError();
4869       }
4870     }
4871 
4872     return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4873                 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
4874        << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
4875   }
4876 
4877   if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4878     ExprResult FromRes =
4879       PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4880     if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4881       return ExprError();
4882     From = FromRes.get();
4883   }
4884 
4885   if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
4886     From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
4887                              From->getValueKind()).get();
4888   return From;
4889 }
4890 
4891 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4892 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
4893 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4894 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
4895   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
4896                                /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4897                                /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
4898                                /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4899                                /*CStyle=*/false,
4900                                /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4901                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4902 }
4903 
4904 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4905 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
4906 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
4907   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4908     return ExprError();
4909 
4910   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
4911   if (!ICS.isBad())
4912     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
4913 
4914   if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
4915     return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4916                 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
4917                   << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
4918   return ExprError();
4919 }
4920 
4921 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
4922 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
4923 /// is acceptable.
4924 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
4925                                               StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4926   // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
4927   // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
4928   // conversions are fine.
4929   switch (SCS.Second) {
4930   case ICK_Identity:
4931   case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
4932   case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
4933   case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion:
4934     return true;
4935 
4936   case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
4937     // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
4938     // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral
4939     // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression.
4940     return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
4941            SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
4942 
4943   case ICK_Floating_Integral:
4944   case ICK_Complex_Real:
4945     return false;
4946 
4947   case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
4948   case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
4949   case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
4950   case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment:
4951   case ICK_Qualification:
4952   case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
4953   case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
4954   case ICK_Vector_Splat:
4955   case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
4956   case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
4957   case ICK_Pointer_Member:
4958   case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
4959   case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
4960   case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
4961   case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
4962   case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
4963   case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
4964   case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
4965     llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind");
4966 
4967   case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
4968     break;
4969   }
4970 
4971   llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
4972 }
4973 
4974 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
4975 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
4976 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
4977 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
4978                                                   llvm::APSInt &Value,
4979                                                   CCEKind CCE) {
4980   assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus11 && "converted constant expression outside C++11");
4981   assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
4982 
4983   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4984     return ExprError();
4985 
4986   // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes:
4987   //  A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression,
4988   //  implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted
4989   //  expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion
4990   //  sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue
4991   //  conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than
4992   //  narrowing conversions.
4993   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4994     TryImplicitConversion(From, T,
4995                           /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4996                           /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4997                           /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4998                           /*CStyle=*/false,
4999                           /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false);
5000   StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr;
5001   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5002   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5003     if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard))
5004       return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5005                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
5006                << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5007     SCS = &ICS.Standard;
5008     break;
5009   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5010     // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so
5011     // the Before sequence must be trivial.
5012     if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After))
5013       return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5014                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
5015                << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5016     SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
5017     break;
5018   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5019   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5020     if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
5021       return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5022                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
5023                     << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5024     return ExprError();
5025 
5026   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5027     llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
5028   }
5029 
5030   ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting);
5031   if (Result.isInvalid())
5032     return Result;
5033 
5034   // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
5035   APValue PreNarrowingValue;
5036   QualType PreNarrowingType;
5037   switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
5038                                 PreNarrowingType)) {
5039   case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
5040     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
5041     // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
5042   case NK_Not_Narrowing:
5043     break;
5044 
5045   case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
5046     Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
5047       << CCE << /*Constant*/1
5048       << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
5049     break;
5050 
5051   case NK_Type_Narrowing:
5052     Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
5053       << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
5054     break;
5055   }
5056 
5057   // Check the expression is a constant expression.
5058   SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
5059   Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5060   Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5061 
5062   if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context) || !Eval.Val.isInt()) {
5063     // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5064     // the AST.
5065     Result = ExprError();
5066   } else {
5067     Value = Eval.Val.getInt();
5068 
5069     if (Notes.empty()) {
5070       // It's a constant expression.
5071       return Result;
5072     }
5073   }
5074 
5075   // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5076   if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5077       Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
5078     Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5079   else {
5080     Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
5081       << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5082     for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5083       Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5084   }
5085   return Result;
5086 }
5087 
5088 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5089 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them.  This may change
5090 /// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5091 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5092   if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5093     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5094     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5095     SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5096   }
5097 }
5098 
5099 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5100 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5101 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5102 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5103   // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5104   QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5105   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5106     = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5107                             // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5108                             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5109                             /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
5110                             /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5111                             /*CStyle=*/false,
5112                             /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5113                             /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true);
5114 
5115   // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5116   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5117   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5118   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5119   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5120     break;
5121 
5122   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5123     dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5124     break;
5125 
5126   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5127     dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5128     break;
5129   }
5130 
5131   return ICS;
5132 }
5133 
5134 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5135 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5136 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
5137   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5138     return ExprError();
5139 
5140   QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
5141   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5142     TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
5143   if (!ICS.isBad())
5144     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
5145   return ExprError();
5146 }
5147 
5148 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5149 /// type of a permitted flavor.
5150 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) {
5151   return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5152                                  : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
5153 }
5154 
5155 static ExprResult
5156 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5157                             Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5158                             QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) {
5159 
5160   if (Converter.Suppress)
5161     return ExprError();
5162 
5163   Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5164   for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5165     CXXConversionDecl *Conv =
5166         cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5167     QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5168     Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy);
5169   }
5170   return From;
5171 }
5172 
5173 static bool
5174 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5175                            Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5176                            QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5177                            UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) {
5178   if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) {
5179     DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5180     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5181         cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5182 
5183     // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5184     // conversion; use it.
5185     QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5186     std::string TypeStr;
5187     ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy());
5188 
5189     Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5190         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
5191                                       "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5192         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
5193                SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()), ")");
5194     Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy);
5195 
5196     // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
5197     // explicit conversion function.
5198     if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5199       return true;
5200 
5201     SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
5202     ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5203                                                        HadMultipleCandidates);
5204     if (Result.isInvalid())
5205       return true;
5206     // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5207     From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5208                                     CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5209                                     nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind());
5210   }
5211   return false;
5212 }
5213 
5214 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5215                              Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5216                              QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5217                              DeclAccessPair &Found) {
5218   CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5219       cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5220   SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
5221 
5222   QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5223   if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) {
5224     if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5225       return true;
5226 
5227     Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType)
5228         << From->getSourceRange();
5229   }
5230 
5231   ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5232                                                      HadMultipleCandidates);
5233   if (Result.isInvalid())
5234     return true;
5235   // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5236   From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5237                                   CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5238                                   nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind());
5239   return false;
5240 }
5241 
5242 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion(
5243     Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5244     Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
5245   if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress)
5246     Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType())
5247         << From->getSourceRange();
5248 
5249   return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
5250 }
5251 
5252 static void
5253 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5254                                   UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions,
5255                                   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5256   for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5257     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I];
5258     NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
5259     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
5260     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5261       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
5262 
5263     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
5264     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
5265     if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
5266       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5267     else
5268       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5269 
5270     if (ConvTemplate)
5271       SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
5272         ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet,
5273         /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5274     else
5275       SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From,
5276                                      ToType, CandidateSet,
5277                                      /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5278   }
5279 }
5280 
5281 /// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted
5282 /// by the given converter.
5283 ///
5284 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a
5285 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class
5286 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching
5287 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only
5288 /// one target type.
5289 ///
5290 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
5291 /// conversion.
5292 ///
5293 /// \param From The expression we're converting from.
5294 ///
5295 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process.
5296 ///
5297 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
5298 /// successful.
5299 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion(
5300     SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
5301   // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
5302   if (From->isTypeDependent())
5303     return From;
5304 
5305   // Process placeholders immediately.
5306   if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
5307     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
5308     if (result.isInvalid())
5309       return result;
5310     From = result.get();
5311   }
5312 
5313   // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden.
5314   QualType T = From->getType();
5315   if (Converter.match(T))
5316     return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
5317 
5318   // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
5319 
5320   // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class
5321   // type.
5322   const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
5323   if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5324     if (!Converter.Suppress)
5325       Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5326     return From;
5327   }
5328 
5329   // We must have a complete class type.
5330   struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
5331     ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter;
5332     Expr *From;
5333 
5334     TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From)
5335         : TypeDiagnoser(Converter.Suppress), Converter(Converter), From(From) {}
5336 
5337     void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
5338       Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5339     }
5340   } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From);
5341 
5342   if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
5343     return From;
5344 
5345   // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
5346   UnresolvedSet<4>
5347       ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y.
5348   UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
5349   std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
5350             CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions =
5351       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
5352 
5353   bool HadMultipleCandidates =
5354       (std::distance(Conversions.first, Conversions.second) > 1);
5355 
5356   // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y:
5357   QualType ToType;
5358   bool HasUniqueTargetType = true;
5359 
5360   // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions.
5361   for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator I = Conversions.first,
5362                                           E = Conversions.second;
5363        I != E; ++I) {
5364     NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
5365     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion;
5366     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
5367     if (ConvTemplate) {
5368       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y)
5369         Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5370       else
5371         continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?).
5372     } else
5373       Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5374 
5375     assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y) &&
5376            "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially "
5377            "viable in C++1y");
5378 
5379     QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5380     if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) {
5381 
5382       if (Conversion->isExplicit()) {
5383         // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction?
5384         // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion()
5385         if (!ConvTemplate)
5386           ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5387       } else {
5388         if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y) {
5389           if (ToType.isNull())
5390             ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType();
5391           else if (HasUniqueTargetType &&
5392                    (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType))
5393             HasUniqueTargetType = false;
5394         }
5395         ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5396       }
5397     }
5398   }
5399 
5400   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y) {
5401     // C++1y [conv]p6:
5402     // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context
5403     // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified
5404     // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly
5405     // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched
5406     // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to
5407     // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be
5408     // exactly one such T.
5409 
5410     // If no unique T is found:
5411     if (ToType.isNull()) {
5412       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5413                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
5414                                      ExplicitConversions))
5415         return ExprError();
5416       return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
5417     }
5418 
5419     // If more than one unique Ts are found:
5420     if (!HasUniqueTargetType)
5421       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5422                                          ViableConversions);
5423 
5424     // If one unique T is found:
5425     // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded
5426     // potentially viable conversions.
5427     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
5428     collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions,
5429                                       CandidateSet);
5430 
5431     // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set.
5432     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
5433     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) {
5434     case OR_Success: {
5435       // Apply this conversion.
5436       DeclAccessPair Found =
5437           DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
5438       if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5439                            HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
5440         return ExprError();
5441       break;
5442     }
5443     case OR_Ambiguous:
5444       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5445                                          ViableConversions);
5446     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
5447       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5448                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
5449                                      ExplicitConversions))
5450         return ExprError();
5451     // fall through 'OR_Deleted' case.
5452     case OR_Deleted:
5453       // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5454       break;
5455     }
5456   } else {
5457     switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
5458     case 0: {
5459       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5460                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
5461                                      ExplicitConversions))
5462         return ExprError();
5463 
5464       // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5465       break;
5466     }
5467     case 1: {
5468       // Apply this conversion.
5469       DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
5470       if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5471                            HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
5472         return ExprError();
5473       break;
5474     }
5475     default:
5476       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5477                                          ViableConversions);
5478     }
5479   }
5480 
5481   return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
5482 }
5483 
5484 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is
5485 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose
5486 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine
5487 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning
5488 /// enumeration types.
5489 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context,
5490                                                    FunctionDecl *Fn,
5491                                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
5492   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
5493   QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType();
5494 
5495   if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType()))
5496     return true;
5497 
5498   if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType()))
5499     return true;
5500 
5501   const FunctionProtoType *Proto = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
5502   if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1)
5503     return false;
5504 
5505   if (T1->isEnumeralType()) {
5506     QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType();
5507     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType))
5508       return true;
5509   }
5510 
5511   if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2)
5512     return false;
5513 
5514   if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) {
5515     QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType();
5516     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType))
5517       return true;
5518   }
5519 
5520   return false;
5521 }
5522 
5523 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
5524 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments.  If
5525 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
5526 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
5527 ///
5528 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
5529 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
5530 /// code completion.
5531 void
5532 Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
5533                            DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
5534                            ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5535                            OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
5536                            bool SuppressUserConversions,
5537                            bool PartialOverloading,
5538                            bool AllowExplicit) {
5539   const FunctionProtoType *Proto
5540     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
5541   assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
5542   assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
5543          "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
5544 
5545   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
5546     if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
5547       // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
5548       // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
5549       // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
5550       // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
5551       // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
5552       // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
5553       // is irrelevant.
5554       AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
5555                          QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
5556                          Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
5557       return;
5558     }
5559     // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
5560     // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
5561   }
5562 
5563   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
5564     return;
5565 
5566   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5567   //   if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the
5568   //   lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to
5569   //   (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there
5570   //   is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to
5571   //   (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are
5572   //   candidate functions.
5573   if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator &&
5574       !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args))
5575     return;
5576 
5577   // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402]
5578   //   A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by
5579   //   overload resolution.
5580   CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function);
5581   if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() &&
5582       Constructor->isMoveConstructor())
5583     return;
5584 
5585   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
5586   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
5587 
5588   if (Constructor) {
5589     // C++ [class.copy]p3:
5590     //   A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
5591     //   of a class object to an object of its class type.
5592     QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
5593     if (Args.size() == 1 &&
5594         Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
5595         (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5596          IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
5597       return;
5598   }
5599 
5600   // Add this candidate
5601   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
5602   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5603   Candidate.Function = Function;
5604   Candidate.Viable = true;
5605   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5606   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
5607   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
5608 
5609   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
5610 
5611   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5612   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5613   // list (8.3.5).
5614   if ((Args.size() + (PartialOverloading && Args.size())) > NumParams &&
5615       !Proto->isVariadic()) {
5616     Candidate.Viable = false;
5617     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
5618     return;
5619   }
5620 
5621   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5622   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5623   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5624   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5625   // exactly m parameters.
5626   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
5627   if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
5628     // Not enough arguments.
5629     Candidate.Viable = false;
5630     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
5631     return;
5632   }
5633 
5634   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
5635   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
5636     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
5637       if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
5638         Candidate.Viable = false;
5639         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
5640         return;
5641       }
5642 
5643   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5644   // arguments.
5645   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
5646     if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
5647       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5648       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5649       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5650       // parameter of F.
5651       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
5652       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
5653         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
5654                                 SuppressUserConversions,
5655                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5656                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5657                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
5658                                 AllowExplicit);
5659       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5660         Candidate.Viable = false;
5661         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
5662         return;
5663       }
5664     } else {
5665       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5666       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5667       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
5668       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
5669     }
5670   }
5671 
5672   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Function, Args)) {
5673     Candidate.Viable = false;
5674     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
5675     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
5676     return;
5677   }
5678 }
5679 
5680 static bool IsNotEnableIfAttr(Attr *A) { return !isa<EnableIfAttr>(A); }
5681 
5682 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5683                                   bool MissingImplicitThis) {
5684   // FIXME: specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> iterates in reverse order, but
5685   // we need to find the first failing one.
5686   if (!Function->hasAttrs())
5687     return nullptr;
5688   AttrVec Attrs = Function->getAttrs();
5689   AttrVec::iterator E = std::remove_if(Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(),
5690                                        IsNotEnableIfAttr);
5691   if (Attrs.begin() == E)
5692     return nullptr;
5693   std::reverse(Attrs.begin(), E);
5694 
5695   SFINAETrap Trap(*this);
5696 
5697   // Convert the arguments.
5698   SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs;
5699   bool InitializationFailed = false;
5700   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5701     if (i == 0 && !MissingImplicitThis && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Function) &&
5702         !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)->isStatic() &&
5703         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)) {
5704       CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function);
5705       ExprResult R =
5706         PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
5707                                             Method, Method);
5708       if (R.isInvalid()) {
5709         InitializationFailed = true;
5710         break;
5711       }
5712       ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
5713     } else {
5714       ExprResult R =
5715         PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
5716                                                 Context,
5717                                                 Function->getParamDecl(i)),
5718                                   SourceLocation(),
5719                                   Args[i]);
5720       if (R.isInvalid()) {
5721         InitializationFailed = true;
5722         break;
5723       }
5724       ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
5725     }
5726   }
5727 
5728   if (InitializationFailed || Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
5729     return cast<EnableIfAttr>(Attrs[0]);
5730 
5731   for (AttrVec::iterator I = Attrs.begin(); I != E; ++I) {
5732     APValue Result;
5733     EnableIfAttr *EIA = cast<EnableIfAttr>(*I);
5734     if (!EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution(
5735             Result, Context, Function,
5736             ArrayRef<const Expr*>(ConvertedArgs.data(),
5737                                   ConvertedArgs.size())) ||
5738         !Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue()) {
5739       return EIA;
5740     }
5741   }
5742   return nullptr;
5743 }
5744 
5745 /// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
5746 /// the overload candidate set.
5747 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
5748                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5749                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5750                                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
5751                                TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
5752   for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
5753     NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5754     if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
5755       if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
5756         AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
5757                            cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
5758                            Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
5759                            Args.slice(1), CandidateSet,
5760                            SuppressUserConversions);
5761       else
5762         AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet,
5763                              SuppressUserConversions);
5764     } else {
5765       FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
5766       if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5767           !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
5768         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
5769                               cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
5770                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs,
5771                                    Args[0]->getType(),
5772                                    Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
5773                                    CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
5774       else
5775         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
5776                                      ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5777                                      CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
5778     }
5779   }
5780 }
5781 
5782 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
5783 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
5784 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
5785                               QualType ObjectType,
5786                               Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
5787                               ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5788                               OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5789                               bool SuppressUserConversions) {
5790   NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
5791   CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
5792 
5793   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
5794     Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
5795 
5796   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
5797     assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5798            "Expected a member function template");
5799     AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
5800                                /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr,
5801                                ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5802                                Args, CandidateSet,
5803                                SuppressUserConversions);
5804   } else {
5805     AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
5806                        ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5807                        Args,
5808                        CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
5809   }
5810 }
5811 
5812 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
5813 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
5814 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
5815 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
5816 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
5817 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
5818 /// operators.
5819 void
5820 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
5821                          CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
5822                          Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
5823                          ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5824                          OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
5825                          bool SuppressUserConversions) {
5826   const FunctionProtoType *Proto
5827     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
5828   assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
5829   assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
5830          "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
5831 
5832   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
5833     return;
5834 
5835   // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402]
5836   //   A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is
5837   //   ignored by overload resolution.
5838   if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() &&
5839       Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
5840     return;
5841 
5842   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
5843   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
5844 
5845   // Add this candidate
5846   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
5847   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5848   Candidate.Function = Method;
5849   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5850   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
5851   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
5852 
5853   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
5854 
5855   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5856   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5857   // list (8.3.5).
5858   if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
5859     Candidate.Viable = false;
5860     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
5861     return;
5862   }
5863 
5864   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5865   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5866   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5867   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5868   // exactly m parameters.
5869   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
5870   if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs) {
5871     // Not enough arguments.
5872     Candidate.Viable = false;
5873     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
5874     return;
5875   }
5876 
5877   Candidate.Viable = true;
5878 
5879   if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
5880     // The implicit object argument is ignored.
5881     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
5882   else {
5883     // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
5884     // parameter.
5885     Candidate.Conversions[0]
5886       = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5887                                         Method, ActingContext);
5888     if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
5889       Candidate.Viable = false;
5890       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
5891       return;
5892     }
5893   }
5894 
5895   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5896   // arguments.
5897   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
5898     if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
5899       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5900       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5901       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5902       // parameter of F.
5903       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
5904       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
5905         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
5906                                 SuppressUserConversions,
5907                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5908                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5909                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
5910       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
5911         Candidate.Viable = false;
5912         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
5913         return;
5914       }
5915     } else {
5916       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5917       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5918       // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
5919       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
5920     }
5921   }
5922 
5923   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) {
5924     Candidate.Viable = false;
5925     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
5926     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
5927     return;
5928   }
5929 }
5930 
5931 /// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
5932 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
5933 /// function template specialization.
5934 void
5935 Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
5936                                  DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
5937                                  CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
5938                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
5939                                  QualType ObjectType,
5940                                  Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
5941                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5942                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5943                                  bool SuppressUserConversions) {
5944   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
5945     return;
5946 
5947   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
5948   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
5949   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
5950   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
5951   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5952   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5953   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5954   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5955   //   functions.
5956   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
5957   FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
5958   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
5959       = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5960                                 Specialization, Info)) {
5961     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
5962     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5963     Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
5964     Candidate.Viable = false;
5965     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5966     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5967     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
5968     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
5969     Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
5970                                                           Info);
5971     return;
5972   }
5973 
5974   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5975   // deduction as a candidate.
5976   assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
5977   assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
5978          "Specialization is not a member function?");
5979   AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
5980                      ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
5981                      CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
5982 }
5983 
5984 /// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
5985 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
5986 /// an appropriate function template specialization.
5987 void
5988 Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
5989                                    DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
5990                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
5991                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5992                                    OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5993                                    bool SuppressUserConversions) {
5994   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5995     return;
5996 
5997   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
5998   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
5999   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
6000   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
6001   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
6002   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
6003   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
6004   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
6005   //   functions.
6006   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
6007   FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
6008   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
6009         = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
6010                                   Specialization, Info)) {
6011     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
6012     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6013     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
6014     Candidate.Viable = false;
6015     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
6016     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6017     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6018     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6019     Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
6020                                                           Info);
6021     return;
6022   }
6023 
6024   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
6025   // deduction as a candidate.
6026   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
6027   AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
6028                        SuppressUserConversions);
6029 }
6030 
6031 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result
6032 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++
6033 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1.
6034 ///
6035 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function.
6036 ///
6037 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to.
6038 ///
6039 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one
6040 /// Objective-C pointer to another.
6041 ///
6042 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise.
6043 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S,
6044                                           QualType ConvType, QualType ToType,
6045                                           bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) {
6046   QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
6047 
6048   // Easy case: the types are the same.
6049   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType))
6050     return true;
6051 
6052   // Allow qualification conversions.
6053   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
6054   if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false,
6055                                   ObjCLifetimeConversion))
6056     return true;
6057 
6058   // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions,
6059   // we're done.
6060   if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion)
6061     return false;
6062 
6063   // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion?
6064   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
6065   QualType ConvertedType;
6066   return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType,
6067                                    IncompatibleObjC);
6068 }
6069 
6070 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
6071 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
6072 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
6073 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
6074 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
6075 /// conversion function produces).
6076 void
6077 Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
6078                              DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6079                              CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
6080                              Expr *From, QualType ToType,
6081                              OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6082                              bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
6083   assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
6084          "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
6085   QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
6086   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
6087     return;
6088 
6089   // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its
6090   // deduction now.
6091   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) {
6092     if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc()))
6093       return;
6094     ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
6095   }
6096 
6097   // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion
6098   // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or
6099   // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion.
6100   if (Conversion->isExplicit() &&
6101       !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType,
6102                                      AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit))
6103     return;
6104 
6105   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6106   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
6107 
6108   // Add this candidate
6109   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
6110   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6111   Candidate.Function = Conversion;
6112   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6113   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6114   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
6115   Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
6116   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
6117   Candidate.Viable = true;
6118   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
6119 
6120   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
6121   //   For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
6122   //   the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
6123   //   defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
6124   //
6125   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
6126   // object parameter.
6127   QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
6128   if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
6129     ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
6130   CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
6131     = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
6132 
6133   Candidate.Conversions[0]
6134     = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
6135                                       From->Classify(Context),
6136                                       Conversion, ConversionContext);
6137 
6138   if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
6139     Candidate.Viable = false;
6140     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6141     return;
6142   }
6143 
6144   // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a
6145   // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
6146   // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
6147   QualType FromCanon
6148     = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
6149   QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
6150   if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
6151     Candidate.Viable = false;
6152     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
6153     return;
6154   }
6155 
6156   // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
6157   // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
6158   // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
6159   // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
6160   // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
6161   // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
6162   // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
6163   // well-formed.
6164   DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
6165                             VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
6166   ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
6167                                 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
6168                                 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
6169                                 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
6170 
6171   QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
6172   if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
6173     Candidate.Viable = false;
6174     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
6175     return;
6176   }
6177 
6178   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
6179 
6180   // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
6181   // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
6182   // allocator).
6183   QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
6184   CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, None, CallResultType, VK,
6185                 From->getLocStart());
6186   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
6187     TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
6188                           /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
6189                           /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6190                           /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
6191 
6192   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
6193   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
6194     Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
6195 
6196     // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
6197     //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
6198     //   conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
6199     //   shall have exact match rank.
6200     if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
6201         GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
6202       Candidate.Viable = false;
6203       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
6204       return;
6205     }
6206 
6207     // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
6208     //    In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
6209     //    the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
6210     //    conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
6211     //    program is ill-formed.
6212     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
6213         ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
6214       Candidate.Viable = false;
6215       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
6216       return;
6217     }
6218     break;
6219 
6220   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
6221     Candidate.Viable = false;
6222     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
6223     return;
6224 
6225   default:
6226     llvm_unreachable(
6227            "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
6228   }
6229 
6230   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, ArrayRef<Expr*>())) {
6231     Candidate.Viable = false;
6232     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6233     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6234     return;
6235   }
6236 }
6237 
6238 /// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
6239 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
6240 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
6241 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
6242 /// [temp.deduct.conv]).
6243 void
6244 Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
6245                                      DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6246                                      CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
6247                                      Expr *From, QualType ToType,
6248                                      OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6249                                      bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
6250   assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
6251          "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
6252 
6253   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
6254     return;
6255 
6256   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
6257   CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
6258   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
6259         = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
6260                                   Specialization, Info)) {
6261     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
6262     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6263     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
6264     Candidate.Viable = false;
6265     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
6266     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6267     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6268     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
6269     Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
6270                                                           Info);
6271     return;
6272   }
6273 
6274   // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
6275   // template argument deduction as a candidate.
6276   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
6277   AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
6278                          CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
6279 }
6280 
6281 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
6282 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
6283 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
6284 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
6285 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
6286 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
6287                                  DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6288                                  CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
6289                                  const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
6290                                  Expr *Object,
6291                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6292                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
6293   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
6294     return;
6295 
6296   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6297   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
6298 
6299   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
6300   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6301   Candidate.Function = nullptr;
6302   Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
6303   Candidate.Viable = true;
6304   Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
6305   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6306   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6307 
6308   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
6309   // object parameter.
6310   ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
6311     = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
6312                                       Object->Classify(Context),
6313                                       Conversion, ActingContext);
6314   if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
6315     Candidate.Viable = false;
6316     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6317     Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
6318     return;
6319   }
6320 
6321   // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
6322   // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
6323   // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
6324   Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
6325   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
6326   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
6327   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
6328   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
6329   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
6330   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
6331     = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
6332   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
6333 
6334   // Find the
6335   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
6336 
6337   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6338   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6339   // list (8.3.5).
6340   if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
6341     Candidate.Viable = false;
6342     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
6343     return;
6344   }
6345 
6346   // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
6347   // we have enough arguments.
6348   if (Args.size() < NumParams) {
6349     // Not enough arguments.
6350     Candidate.Viable = false;
6351     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
6352     return;
6353   }
6354 
6355   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6356   // arguments.
6357   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
6358     if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
6359       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6360       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6361       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6362       // parameter of F.
6363       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
6364       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
6365         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
6366                                 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
6367                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6368                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6369                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
6370       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
6371         Candidate.Viable = false;
6372         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6373         return;
6374       }
6375     } else {
6376       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6377       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6378       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
6379       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
6380     }
6381   }
6382 
6383   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, ArrayRef<Expr*>())) {
6384     Candidate.Viable = false;
6385     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6386     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6387     return;
6388   }
6389 }
6390 
6391 /// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
6392 /// member functions.
6393 ///
6394 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
6395 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
6396 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
6397 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
6398 /// [over.match.oper]).
6399 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
6400                                        SourceLocation OpLoc,
6401                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6402                                        OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6403                                        SourceRange OpRange) {
6404   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
6405 
6406   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6407   //   For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
6408   //   cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
6409   //   a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
6410   //   a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
6411   //   three sets of candidate functions, designated member
6412   //   candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
6413   //   constructed as follows:
6414   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
6415 
6416   //     -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being
6417   //        defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the
6418   //        qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise,
6419   //        the set of member candidates is empty.
6420   if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
6421     // Complete the type if it can be completed.
6422     RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, 0);
6423     // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now.
6424     if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition())
6425       return;
6426 
6427     LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
6428     LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
6429     Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
6430 
6431     for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
6432                              OperEnd = Operators.end();
6433          Oper != OperEnd;
6434          ++Oper)
6435       AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
6436                          Args[0]->Classify(Context),
6437                          Args.slice(1),
6438                          CandidateSet,
6439                          /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
6440   }
6441 }
6442 
6443 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
6444 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
6445 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
6446 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
6447 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
6448 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
6449 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
6450 /// converted to bool.
6451 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
6452                                ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6453                                OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6454                                bool IsAssignmentOperator,
6455                                unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
6456   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6457   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
6458 
6459   // Add this candidate
6460   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
6461   Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none);
6462   Candidate.Function = nullptr;
6463   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6464   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6465   Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
6466   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
6467     Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
6468 
6469   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6470   // arguments.
6471   Candidate.Viable = true;
6472   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6473   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
6474     // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
6475     //   For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
6476     //   left operand are restricted as follows:
6477     //     -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
6478     //     -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
6479     //        operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
6480     //        parameter of a built-in candidate.
6481     //
6482     // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
6483     // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
6484     // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
6485     // is not of the same type.
6486     if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
6487       assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
6488              "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
6489       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
6490         = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
6491     } else {
6492       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
6493         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
6494                                 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
6495                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6496                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6497                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
6498     }
6499     if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
6500       Candidate.Viable = false;
6501       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6502       break;
6503     }
6504   }
6505 }
6506 
6507 namespace {
6508 
6509 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
6510 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
6511 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
6512 /// enumeration types.
6513 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet  {
6514   /// TypeSet - A set of types.
6515   typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
6516 
6517   /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
6518   /// built-in candidates.
6519   TypeSet PointerTypes;
6520 
6521   /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
6522   /// used in the built-in candidates.
6523   TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
6524 
6525   /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
6526   /// used in the built-in candidates.
6527   TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
6528 
6529   /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
6530   /// candidates.
6531   TypeSet VectorTypes;
6532 
6533   /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
6534   bool HasNonRecordTypes;
6535 
6536   /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
6537   /// were present in the candidate set.
6538   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
6539 
6540   /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
6541   /// candidate set.
6542   bool HasNullPtrType;
6543 
6544   /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
6545   /// candidate type set.
6546   Sema &SemaRef;
6547 
6548   /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
6549   ASTContext &Context;
6550 
6551   bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6552                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
6553   bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
6554 
6555 public:
6556   /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
6557   typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
6558 
6559   BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
6560     : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
6561       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
6562       HasNullPtrType(false),
6563       SemaRef(SemaRef),
6564       Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
6565 
6566   void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
6567                              SourceLocation Loc,
6568                              bool AllowUserConversions,
6569                              bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6570                              const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
6571 
6572   /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
6573   iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
6574 
6575   /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
6576   iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
6577 
6578   /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
6579   iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
6580 
6581   /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
6582   iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
6583 
6584   /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
6585   iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
6586 
6587   /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
6588   iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
6589 
6590   iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
6591   iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
6592 
6593   bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
6594   bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
6595   bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
6596 };
6597 
6598 } // end anonymous namespace
6599 
6600 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
6601 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6602 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6603 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6604 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6605 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6606 /// false otherwise.
6607 ///
6608 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
6609 bool
6610 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6611                                              const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
6612 
6613   // Insert this type.
6614   if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
6615     return false;
6616 
6617   QualType PointeeTy;
6618   const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
6619   bool buildObjCPtr = false;
6620   if (!PointerTy) {
6621     const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6622     PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6623     buildObjCPtr = true;
6624   } else {
6625     PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
6626   }
6627 
6628   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6629   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6630   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6631   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6632   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6633     return true;
6634 
6635   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6636   bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
6637   bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
6638 
6639   // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
6640   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6641     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
6642     // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
6643     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
6644 
6645     // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
6646     // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
6647     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
6648         (!hasRestrict ||
6649          (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
6650       continue;
6651 
6652     // Build qualified pointee type.
6653     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
6654 
6655     // Build qualified pointer type.
6656     QualType QPointerTy;
6657     if (!buildObjCPtr)
6658       QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
6659     else
6660       QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
6661 
6662     // Insert qualified pointer type.
6663     PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
6664   }
6665 
6666   return true;
6667 }
6668 
6669 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
6670 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6671 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6672 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6673 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6674 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6675 /// false otherwise.
6676 ///
6677 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
6678 bool
6679 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
6680     QualType Ty) {
6681   // Insert this type.
6682   if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
6683     return false;
6684 
6685   const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6686   assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
6687 
6688   QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
6689   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6690   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6691   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6692   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6693   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6694     return true;
6695   const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
6696 
6697   // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
6698   // qualifiers.
6699   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6700   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6701     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
6702 
6703     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
6704     MemberPointerTypes.insert(
6705       Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
6706   }
6707 
6708   return true;
6709 }
6710 
6711 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
6712 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
6713 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
6714 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
6715 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
6716 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
6717 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
6718 /// type.
6719 void
6720 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
6721                                                SourceLocation Loc,
6722                                                bool AllowUserConversions,
6723                                                bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6724                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
6725   // Only deal with canonical types.
6726   Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
6727 
6728   // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
6729   // expression for the purposes of conversions.
6730   if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6731     Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
6732 
6733   // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
6734   if (Ty->isArrayType())
6735     Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
6736 
6737   // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
6738   Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
6739 
6740   // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
6741   const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6742   HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
6743 
6744   // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
6745   HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
6746     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
6747 
6748   if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
6749     PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
6750   else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
6751     // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
6752     // of types.
6753     if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
6754       return;
6755   } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
6756     // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
6757     if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
6758       return;
6759   } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
6760     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
6761     EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
6762   } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
6763     // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
6764     // extension.
6765     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
6766     VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
6767   } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
6768     HasNullPtrType = true;
6769   } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
6770     // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
6771     if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
6772       return;
6773 
6774     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
6775     std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6776               CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6777       Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6778     for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6779            I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
6780       NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6781       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6782         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6783 
6784       // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
6785       // about which builtin types we can convert to.
6786       if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
6787         continue;
6788 
6789       CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6790       if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
6791         AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
6792                               VisibleQuals);
6793       }
6794     }
6795   }
6796 }
6797 
6798 /// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
6799 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
6800 /// given type to the candidate set.
6801 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
6802                                                    QualType T,
6803                                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6804                                     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
6805   QualType ParamTypes[2];
6806 
6807   // T& operator=(T&, T)
6808   ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6809   ParamTypes[1] = T;
6810   S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
6811                         /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
6812 
6813   if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
6814     // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
6815     ParamTypes[0]
6816       = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
6817     ParamTypes[1] = T;
6818     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
6819                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
6820   }
6821 }
6822 
6823 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
6824 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
6825 static  Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
6826     Qualifiers VRQuals;
6827     const RecordType *TyRec;
6828     if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
6829         ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
6830       TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
6831     else
6832       TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
6833     if (!TyRec) {
6834       // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
6835       VRQuals.addVolatile();
6836       VRQuals.addRestrict();
6837       return VRQuals;
6838     }
6839 
6840     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
6841     if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
6842       return VRQuals;
6843 
6844     std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6845               CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6846       Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6847 
6848     for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6849            I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
6850       NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6851       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6852         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6853       if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
6854         QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
6855         if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6856           CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6857         // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
6858         // as see them.
6859         bool done = false;
6860         while (!done) {
6861           if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
6862             VRQuals.addRestrict();
6863           if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6864             CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
6865           else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
6866                 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
6867             CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
6868           else
6869             done = true;
6870           if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
6871             VRQuals.addVolatile();
6872           if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
6873             return VRQuals;
6874         }
6875       }
6876     }
6877     return VRQuals;
6878 }
6879 
6880 namespace {
6881 
6882 /// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
6883 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
6884 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
6885 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
6886 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
6887   // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
6888   Sema &S;
6889   ArrayRef<Expr *> Args;
6890   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
6891   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
6892   SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
6893   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
6894 
6895   // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
6896   // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
6897   // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
6898   // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
6899   static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
6900   static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 20;
6901   static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
6902                         LastPromotedIntegralType = 11;
6903   static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
6904                         LastPromotedArithmeticType = 11;
6905   static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 20;
6906 
6907   /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
6908   CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
6909     assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
6910     static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
6911       ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
6912       // Start of promoted types.
6913       &ASTContext::FloatTy,
6914       &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
6915       &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
6916 
6917       // Start of integral types.
6918       &ASTContext::IntTy,
6919       &ASTContext::LongTy,
6920       &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
6921       &ASTContext::Int128Ty,
6922       &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
6923       &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
6924       &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
6925       &ASTContext::UnsignedInt128Ty,
6926       // End of promoted types.
6927 
6928       &ASTContext::BoolTy,
6929       &ASTContext::CharTy,
6930       &ASTContext::WCharTy,
6931       &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
6932       &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
6933       &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
6934       &ASTContext::ShortTy,
6935       &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
6936       &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
6937       // End of integral types.
6938       // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
6939     };
6940     return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
6941   }
6942 
6943   /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
6944   /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
6945   CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
6946     // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
6947     // The rules are basically:
6948     //   - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
6949     //   - if same signedness, use the higher rank
6950     //   - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
6951     //   - use the larger type
6952     // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
6953     // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
6954     // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
6955     // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
6956     // better not to make any assumptions).
6957     // We assume that int128 has a higher rank than long long on all platforms.
6958     enum PromotedType {
6959             Dep=-1,
6960             Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   SI,   SL,  SLL, S128,   UI,   UL,  ULL, U128
6961     };
6962     static const PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
6963                                         [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
6964 /* Flt*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt },
6965 /* Dbl*/ {  Dbl,  Dbl, LDbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl },
6966 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
6967 /*  SI*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   SI,   SL,  SLL, S128,   UI,   UL,  ULL, U128 },
6968 /*  SL*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   SL,   SL,  SLL, S128,  Dep,   UL,  ULL, U128 },
6969 /* SLL*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,  SLL,  SLL,  SLL, S128,  Dep,  Dep,  ULL, U128 },
6970 /*S128*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, U128 },
6971 /*  UI*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   UI,  Dep,  Dep, S128,   UI,   UL,  ULL, U128 },
6972 /*  UL*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   UL,   UL,  Dep, S128,   UL,   UL,  ULL, U128 },
6973 /* ULL*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,  ULL,  ULL,  ULL, S128,  ULL,  ULL,  ULL, U128 },
6974 /*U128*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128 },
6975     };
6976 
6977     assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6978     assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6979     int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
6980 
6981     // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
6982     if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
6983 
6984     // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
6985     // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
6986     CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
6987                 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
6988     unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
6989              RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
6990 
6991     // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
6992     if (LW > RW) return LT;
6993     else if (LW < RW) return RT;
6994 
6995     // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
6996     if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
6997     assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
6998     return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
6999   }
7000 
7001   /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
7002   /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
7003   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
7004                                            bool HasVolatile,
7005                                            bool HasRestrict) {
7006     QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7007       S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
7008       S.Context.IntTy
7009     };
7010 
7011     // Non-volatile version.
7012     if (Args.size() == 1)
7013       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7014     else
7015       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7016 
7017     // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
7018     // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
7019     if (HasVolatile) {
7020       ParamTypes[0] =
7021         S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7022           S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
7023       if (Args.size() == 1)
7024         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7025       else
7026         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7027     }
7028 
7029     // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
7030     // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
7031     if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
7032         !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
7033       ParamTypes[0]
7034         = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7035             S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
7036       if (Args.size() == 1)
7037         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7038       else
7039         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7040 
7041       if (HasVolatile) {
7042         ParamTypes[0]
7043           = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7044               S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
7045                                             (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7046                                              Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7047         if (Args.size() == 1)
7048           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7049         else
7050           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7051       }
7052     }
7053 
7054   }
7055 
7056 public:
7057   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
7058     Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7059     Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
7060     bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
7061     SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
7062     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
7063     : S(S), Args(Args),
7064       VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
7065       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
7066         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
7067       CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
7068       CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
7069     // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
7070     assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
7071            "Invalid first promoted integral type");
7072     assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
7073              == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
7074            "Invalid last promoted integral type");
7075     assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
7076              == S.Context.FloatTy &&
7077            "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
7078     assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
7079              == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
7080            "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
7081   }
7082 
7083   // C++ [over.built]p3:
7084   //
7085   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
7086   //   is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
7087   //   functions of the form
7088   //
7089   //       VQ T&      operator++(VQ T&);
7090   //       T          operator++(VQ T&, int);
7091   //
7092   // C++ [over.built]p4:
7093   //
7094   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
7095   //   than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
7096   //   candidate operator functions of the form
7097   //
7098   //       VQ T&      operator--(VQ T&);
7099   //       T          operator--(VQ T&, int);
7100   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
7101     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7102       return;
7103 
7104     for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
7105          Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
7106       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
7107         getArithmeticType(Arith),
7108         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
7109         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
7110     }
7111   }
7112 
7113   // C++ [over.built]p5:
7114   //
7115   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7116   //   cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
7117   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7118   //
7119   //       T*VQ&      operator++(T*VQ&);
7120   //       T*VQ&      operator--(T*VQ&);
7121   //       T*         operator++(T*VQ&, int);
7122   //       T*         operator--(T*VQ&, int);
7123   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
7124     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7125               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7126            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7127          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7128       // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
7129       if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
7130         continue;
7131 
7132       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
7133         (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7134          VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
7135         (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7136          VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
7137     }
7138   }
7139 
7140   // C++ [over.built]p6:
7141   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
7142   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
7143   //
7144   //       T&         operator*(T*);
7145   //
7146   // C++ [over.built]p7:
7147   //   For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
7148   //   ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7149   //       T&         operator*(T*);
7150   void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
7151     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7152               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7153            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7154          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7155       QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
7156       QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
7157       if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
7158         continue;
7159 
7160       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
7161         if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
7162           continue;
7163 
7164       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
7165                             &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7166     }
7167   }
7168 
7169   // C++ [over.built]p9:
7170   //  For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
7171   //  operator functions of the form
7172   //
7173   //       T         operator+(T);
7174   //       T         operator-(T);
7175   void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
7176     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7177       return;
7178 
7179     for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7180          Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
7181       QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
7182       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7183     }
7184 
7185     // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
7186     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7187               Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7188            VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7189          Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
7190       QualType VecTy = *Vec;
7191       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7192     }
7193   }
7194 
7195   // C++ [over.built]p8:
7196   //   For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
7197   //   the form
7198   //
7199   //       T*         operator+(T*);
7200   void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
7201     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7202               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7203            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7204          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7205       QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
7206       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7207     }
7208   }
7209 
7210   // C++ [over.built]p10:
7211   //   For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
7212   //   operator functions of the form
7213   //
7214   //        T         operator~(T);
7215   void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
7216     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7217       return;
7218 
7219     for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7220          Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
7221       QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
7222       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7223     }
7224 
7225     // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
7226     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7227               Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7228            VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7229          Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
7230       QualType VecTy = *Vec;
7231       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7232     }
7233   }
7234 
7235   // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
7236   //   For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
7237   //   functions of the form
7238   //
7239   //        bool operator==(T,T);
7240   //        bool operator!=(T,T);
7241   void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
7242     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7243     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7244 
7245     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7246       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7247                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7248              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7249            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
7250            ++MemPtr) {
7251         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
7252         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7253           continue;
7254 
7255         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
7256         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7257       }
7258     }
7259   }
7260 
7261   // C++ [over.built]p15:
7262   //
7263   //   For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
7264   //   std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7265   //
7266   //        bool       operator<(T, T);
7267   //        bool       operator>(T, T);
7268   //        bool       operator<=(T, T);
7269   //        bool       operator>=(T, T);
7270   //        bool       operator==(T, T);
7271   //        bool       operator!=(T, T);
7272   void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
7273     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7274     //   [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
7275     //   functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
7276     //   do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
7277     //   candidate.
7278     //
7279     // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
7280     // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
7281     // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
7282     // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
7283     // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
7284     // where we must suppress candidates like this.
7285     llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
7286       UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
7287 
7288     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7289       if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
7290           CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
7291         for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
7292                                          CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7293              C != CEnd; ++C) {
7294           if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
7295             continue;
7296 
7297           if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
7298             continue;
7299 
7300           QualType FirstParamType =
7301             C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7302           QualType SecondParamType =
7303             C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7304 
7305           // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
7306           if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
7307               !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
7308             continue;
7309 
7310           // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
7311           UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
7312             std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
7313                            S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
7314         }
7315       }
7316     }
7317 
7318     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7319     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7320 
7321     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7322       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7323                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7324              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7325            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7326         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
7327         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7328           continue;
7329 
7330         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7331         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7332       }
7333       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7334                 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7335              EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7336            Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7337         CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
7338 
7339         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
7340         // candidate exists.
7341         if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
7342             UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
7343                                                             CanonType)))
7344           continue;
7345 
7346         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
7347         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7348       }
7349 
7350       if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
7351         CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
7352         if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
7353             !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
7354                                                              NullPtrTy))) {
7355           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
7356           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args,
7357                                 CandidateSet);
7358         }
7359       }
7360     }
7361   }
7362 
7363   // C++ [over.built]p13:
7364   //
7365   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
7366   //   there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7367   //
7368   //      T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
7369   //      T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);    [BELOW]
7370   //      T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
7371   //      T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
7372   //      T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);    [BELOW]
7373   //
7374   // C++ [over.built]p14:
7375   //
7376   //   For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
7377   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
7378   //
7379   //      ptrdiff_t  operator-(T, T);
7380   void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
7381     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7382     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7383 
7384     for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
7385       QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
7386         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7387         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7388       };
7389       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7390                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
7391              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
7392            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7393         QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
7394         if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
7395           continue;
7396 
7397         AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
7398         if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
7399           // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
7400           // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
7401           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7402         }
7403         if (Op == OO_Minus) {
7404           // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
7405           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7406             continue;
7407 
7408           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7409           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
7410                                 Args, CandidateSet);
7411         }
7412       }
7413     }
7414   }
7415 
7416   // C++ [over.built]p12:
7417   //
7418   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
7419   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
7420   //
7421   //        LR         operator*(L, R);
7422   //        LR         operator/(L, R);
7423   //        LR         operator+(L, R);
7424   //        LR         operator-(L, R);
7425   //        bool       operator<(L, R);
7426   //        bool       operator>(L, R);
7427   //        bool       operator<=(L, R);
7428   //        bool       operator>=(L, R);
7429   //        bool       operator==(L, R);
7430   //        bool       operator!=(L, R);
7431   //
7432   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7433   //   between types L and R.
7434   //
7435   // C++ [over.built]p24:
7436   //
7437   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
7438   //   candidate operator functions of the form
7439   //
7440   //        LR       operator?(bool, L, R);
7441   //
7442   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7443   //   between types L and R.
7444   // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
7445   void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
7446     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7447       return;
7448 
7449     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7450          Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
7451       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7452            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
7453         QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7454                               getArithmeticType(Right) };
7455         QualType Result =
7456           isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
7457                        : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
7458         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
7459       }
7460     }
7461 
7462     // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
7463     // conditional operator for vector types.
7464     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7465               Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7466            Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7467          Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7468       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7469                 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7470              Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7471            Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7472         QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
7473         QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
7474         if (!isComparison) {
7475           if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
7476             Result = *Vec1;
7477           else
7478             Result = *Vec2;
7479         }
7480 
7481         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
7482       }
7483     }
7484   }
7485 
7486   // C++ [over.built]p17:
7487   //
7488   //   For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
7489   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
7490   //
7491   //      LR         operator%(L, R);
7492   //      LR         operator&(L, R);
7493   //      LR         operator^(L, R);
7494   //      LR         operator|(L, R);
7495   //      L          operator<<(L, R);
7496   //      L          operator>>(L, R);
7497   //
7498   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7499   //   between types L and R.
7500   void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
7501     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7502       return;
7503 
7504     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7505          Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
7506       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7507            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7508         QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7509                               getArithmeticType(Right) };
7510         QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
7511             ? LandR[0]
7512             : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
7513         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
7514       }
7515     }
7516   }
7517 
7518   // C++ [over.built]p20:
7519   //
7520   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
7521   //   pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
7522   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7523   //
7524   //        VQ T&      operator=(VQ T&, T);
7525   void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
7526     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7527     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7528 
7529     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7530       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7531                 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7532              EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7533            Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7534         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7535           continue;
7536 
7537         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, CandidateSet);
7538       }
7539 
7540       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7541                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7542              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7543            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7544         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7545           continue;
7546 
7547         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, CandidateSet);
7548       }
7549     }
7550   }
7551 
7552   // C++ [over.built]p19:
7553   //
7554   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
7555   //   volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
7556   //   of the form
7557   //
7558   //        T*VQ&      operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
7559   //
7560   // C++ [over.built]p21:
7561   //
7562   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7563   //   cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
7564   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7565   //
7566   //        T*VQ&      operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7567   //        T*VQ&      operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7568   void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
7569     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7570     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7571 
7572     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7573               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7574            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7575          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7576       // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
7577       if (isEqualOp)
7578         AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
7579       else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
7580         continue;
7581 
7582       // non-volatile version
7583       QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7584         S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7585         isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7586       };
7587       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7588                             /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
7589 
7590       bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7591                           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7592       if (NeedVolatile) {
7593         // volatile version
7594         ParamTypes[0] =
7595           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
7596         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7597                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7598       }
7599 
7600       if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7601           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7602         // restrict version
7603         ParamTypes[0]
7604           = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
7605         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7606                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7607 
7608         if (NeedVolatile) {
7609           // volatile restrict version
7610           ParamTypes[0]
7611             = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7612                 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7613                                               (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7614                                                Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7615           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7616                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7617         }
7618       }
7619     }
7620 
7621     if (isEqualOp) {
7622       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7623                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7624              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7625            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7626         // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
7627         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7628           continue;
7629 
7630         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7631           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7632           *Ptr,
7633         };
7634 
7635         // non-volatile version
7636         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7637                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7638 
7639         bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7640                            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7641         if (NeedVolatile) {
7642           // volatile version
7643           ParamTypes[0] =
7644             S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
7645           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7646                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7647         }
7648 
7649         if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7650             VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7651           // restrict version
7652           ParamTypes[0]
7653             = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
7654           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7655                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7656 
7657           if (NeedVolatile) {
7658             // volatile restrict version
7659             ParamTypes[0]
7660               = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7661                   S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7662                                                 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7663                                                  Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7664             S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7665                                   /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7666           }
7667         }
7668       }
7669     }
7670   }
7671 
7672   // C++ [over.built]p18:
7673   //
7674   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
7675   //   VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
7676   //   arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
7677   //   the form
7678   //
7679   //        VQ L&      operator=(VQ L&, R);
7680   //        VQ L&      operator*=(VQ L&, R);
7681   //        VQ L&      operator/=(VQ L&, R);
7682   //        VQ L&      operator+=(VQ L&, R);
7683   //        VQ L&      operator-=(VQ L&, R);
7684   void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
7685     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7686       return;
7687 
7688     for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
7689       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7690            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
7691         QualType ParamTypes[2];
7692         ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
7693 
7694         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7695         ParamTypes[0] =
7696           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
7697         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7698                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7699 
7700         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7701         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7702           ParamTypes[0] =
7703             S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
7704           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
7705           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7706                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7707         }
7708       }
7709     }
7710 
7711     // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
7712     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7713               Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7714            Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7715          Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7716       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7717                 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7718              Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7719            Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7720         QualType ParamTypes[2];
7721         ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
7722         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7723         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
7724         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7725                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7726 
7727         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7728         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7729           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
7730           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
7731           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7732                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7733         }
7734       }
7735     }
7736   }
7737 
7738   // C++ [over.built]p22:
7739   //
7740   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
7741   //   is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
7742   //   type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7743   //
7744   //        VQ L&       operator%=(VQ L&, R);
7745   //        VQ L&       operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
7746   //        VQ L&       operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
7747   //        VQ L&       operator&=(VQ L&, R);
7748   //        VQ L&       operator^=(VQ L&, R);
7749   //        VQ L&       operator|=(VQ L&, R);
7750   void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
7751     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7752       return;
7753 
7754     for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
7755       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7756            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7757         QualType ParamTypes[2];
7758         ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
7759 
7760         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7761         ParamTypes[0] =
7762           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
7763         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7764         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7765           // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7766           ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
7767           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
7768           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
7769           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7770         }
7771       }
7772     }
7773   }
7774 
7775   // C++ [over.operator]p23:
7776   //
7777   //   There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
7778   //
7779   //        bool        operator!(bool);
7780   //        bool        operator&&(bool, bool);
7781   //        bool        operator||(bool, bool);
7782   void addExclaimOverload() {
7783     QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
7784     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet,
7785                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7786                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
7787   }
7788   void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
7789     QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
7790     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7791                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7792                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
7793   }
7794 
7795   // C++ [over.built]p13:
7796   //
7797   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
7798   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
7799   //
7800   //        T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
7801   //        T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
7802   //        T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
7803   //        T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);     [ABOVE]
7804   //        T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
7805   void addSubscriptOverloads() {
7806     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7807               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7808            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7809          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7810       QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
7811       QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
7812       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7813         continue;
7814 
7815       QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7816 
7817       // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
7818       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7819     }
7820 
7821     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7822               Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7823            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7824          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7825       QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
7826       QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
7827       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7828         continue;
7829 
7830       QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7831 
7832       // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
7833       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7834     }
7835   }
7836 
7837   // C++ [over.built]p11:
7838   //    For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
7839   //    C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
7840   //    type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
7841   //    there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7842   //
7843   //      CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
7844   //
7845   //    where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
7846   void addArrowStarOverloads() {
7847     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7848              Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7849            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7850          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7851       QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
7852       QualType C1;
7853       QualifierCollector Q1;
7854       C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
7855       if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
7856         continue;
7857       // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
7858       // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
7859       // volatile/restrict type.
7860       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
7861         continue;
7862       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
7863         continue;
7864       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7865                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
7866              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
7867            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7868         const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
7869         QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
7870         C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
7871         if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
7872           break;
7873         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
7874         // build CV12 T&
7875         QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
7876         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
7877             T.isVolatileQualified())
7878           continue;
7879         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
7880             T.isRestrictQualified())
7881           continue;
7882         T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
7883         QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
7884         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7885       }
7886     }
7887   }
7888 
7889   // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
7890   // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
7891   // therefore added as binary.
7892   //
7893   // C++ [over.built]p25:
7894   //   For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
7895   //   enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7896   //
7897   //        T        operator?(bool, T, T);
7898   //
7899   void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
7900     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7901     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7902 
7903     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7904       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7905                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7906              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7907            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7908         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7909           continue;
7910 
7911         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7912         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7913       }
7914 
7915       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7916                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7917              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7918            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7919         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7920           continue;
7921 
7922         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
7923         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7924       }
7925 
7926       if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
7927         for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7928                   Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7929                EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7930              Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7931           if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
7932             continue;
7933 
7934           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7935             continue;
7936 
7937           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
7938           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7939         }
7940       }
7941     }
7942   }
7943 };
7944 
7945 } // end anonymous namespace
7946 
7947 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
7948 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
7949 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
7950 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
7951 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
7952 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7953                                         SourceLocation OpLoc,
7954                                         ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7955                                         OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
7956   // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
7957   // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
7958   // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
7959   // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
7960   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
7961   VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
7962   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
7963     VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
7964 
7965   bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
7966   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
7967   SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
7968   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7969     CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
7970     CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
7971                                                  OpLoc,
7972                                                  true,
7973                                                  (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
7974                                                   Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
7975                                                   Op == OO_PipePipe),
7976                                                  VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
7977     HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
7978         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
7979     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
7980         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
7981         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
7982   }
7983 
7984   // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
7985   // for any of the arguments to the operator.
7986   //
7987   // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
7988   // 'bool' overloads.
7989   if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
7990       !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
7991     return;
7992 
7993   // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
7994   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args,
7995                                            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
7996                                            HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
7997                                            CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
7998 
7999   // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
8000   switch (Op) {
8001   case OO_None:
8002   case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
8003     llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
8004 
8005   case OO_New:
8006   case OO_Delete:
8007   case OO_Array_New:
8008   case OO_Array_Delete:
8009   case OO_Call:
8010     llvm_unreachable(
8011                     "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
8012 
8013   case OO_Comma:
8014   case OO_Arrow:
8015     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
8016     //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
8017     //      operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
8018     break;
8019 
8020   case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
8021     if (Args.size() == 1)
8022       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
8023     // Fall through.
8024 
8025   case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
8026     if (Args.size() == 1) {
8027       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
8028     } else {
8029       OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
8030       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
8031     }
8032     break;
8033 
8034   case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
8035     if (Args.size() == 1)
8036       OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
8037     else
8038       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
8039     break;
8040 
8041   case OO_Slash:
8042     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
8043     break;
8044 
8045   case OO_PlusPlus:
8046   case OO_MinusMinus:
8047     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
8048     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
8049     break;
8050 
8051   case OO_EqualEqual:
8052   case OO_ExclaimEqual:
8053     OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
8054     // Fall through.
8055 
8056   case OO_Less:
8057   case OO_Greater:
8058   case OO_LessEqual:
8059   case OO_GreaterEqual:
8060     OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
8061     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
8062     break;
8063 
8064   case OO_Percent:
8065   case OO_Caret:
8066   case OO_Pipe:
8067   case OO_LessLess:
8068   case OO_GreaterGreater:
8069     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
8070     break;
8071 
8072   case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
8073     if (Args.size() == 1)
8074       // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
8075       //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
8076       //      operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
8077       break;
8078 
8079     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
8080     break;
8081 
8082   case OO_Tilde:
8083     OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
8084     break;
8085 
8086   case OO_Equal:
8087     OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
8088     // Fall through.
8089 
8090   case OO_PlusEqual:
8091   case OO_MinusEqual:
8092     OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
8093     // Fall through.
8094 
8095   case OO_StarEqual:
8096   case OO_SlashEqual:
8097     OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
8098     break;
8099 
8100   case OO_PercentEqual:
8101   case OO_LessLessEqual:
8102   case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
8103   case OO_AmpEqual:
8104   case OO_CaretEqual:
8105   case OO_PipeEqual:
8106     OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
8107     break;
8108 
8109   case OO_Exclaim:
8110     OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
8111     break;
8112 
8113   case OO_AmpAmp:
8114   case OO_PipePipe:
8115     OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
8116     break;
8117 
8118   case OO_Subscript:
8119     OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
8120     break;
8121 
8122   case OO_ArrowStar:
8123     OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
8124     break;
8125 
8126   case OO_Conditional:
8127     OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
8128     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
8129     break;
8130   }
8131 }
8132 
8133 /// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
8134 /// to the set of overloading candidates.
8135 ///
8136 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
8137 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
8138 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
8139 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
8140 void
8141 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
8142                                            SourceLocation Loc,
8143                                            ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8144                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8145                                            OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
8146                                            bool PartialOverloading) {
8147   ADLResult Fns;
8148 
8149   // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
8150   // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
8151   // which means we need to key off the canonical decl.  However,
8152   // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
8153   // right set of default arguments.  What default arguments are
8154   // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
8155 
8156   // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
8157   ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns);
8158 
8159   // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
8160   for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
8161                                    CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
8162        Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
8163     if (Cand->Function) {
8164       Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
8165       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
8166         Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
8167     }
8168 
8169   // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
8170   // set.
8171   for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8172     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
8173     if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
8174       if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
8175         continue;
8176 
8177       AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
8178                            PartialOverloading);
8179     } else
8180       AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
8181                                    FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8182                                    Args, CandidateSet);
8183   }
8184 }
8185 
8186 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
8187 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
8188 bool
8189 isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
8190                           const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
8191                           const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
8192                           SourceLocation Loc,
8193                           bool UserDefinedConversion) {
8194   // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
8195   // functions.
8196   if (!Cand2.Viable)
8197     return Cand1.Viable;
8198   else if (!Cand1.Viable)
8199     return false;
8200 
8201   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
8202   //
8203   //   -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
8204   //      that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
8205   //      any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
8206   //      better nor worse than ICS1(F).
8207   unsigned StartArg = 0;
8208   if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
8209     StartArg = 1;
8210 
8211   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
8212   //   A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
8213   //   viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
8214   //   conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
8215   unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions;
8216   assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
8217   bool HasBetterConversion = false;
8218   for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
8219     switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
8220                                                Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
8221                                                Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
8222     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8223       // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
8224       HasBetterConversion = true;
8225       break;
8226 
8227     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8228       // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
8229       return false;
8230 
8231     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8232       // Do nothing.
8233       break;
8234     }
8235   }
8236 
8237   //    -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
8238   //       ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
8239   if (HasBetterConversion)
8240     return true;
8241 
8242   //   -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
8243   //      (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
8244   //      from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
8245   //      the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
8246   //      conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
8247   //      from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
8248   if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
8249       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
8250       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
8251     // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
8252     // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
8253     // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
8254     // pointer or block.
8255     ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
8256         compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
8257     if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
8258       Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
8259                                                   Cand1.FinalConversion,
8260                                                   Cand2.FinalConversion);
8261 
8262     if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
8263       return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
8264 
8265     // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions
8266     // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per
8267     // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3.
8268   }
8269 
8270   //    -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
8271   //       specialization, or, if not that,
8272   bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function &&
8273                                Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
8274   bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function &&
8275                                Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
8276   if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization)
8277     return Cand2IsSpecialization;
8278 
8279   //   -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
8280   //      template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
8281   //      according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
8282   //      if not that,
8283   if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) {
8284     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
8285           = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
8286                                          Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
8287                                          Loc,
8288                        isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
8289                                                              : TPOC_Call,
8290                                          Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments,
8291                                          Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments))
8292       return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
8293   }
8294 
8295   // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution.
8296   if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
8297       (Cand1.Function->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>() ||
8298        Cand2.Function->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>())) {
8299     // FIXME: The next several lines are just
8300     // specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> but going in declaration order,
8301     // instead of reverse order which is how they're stored in the AST.
8302     AttrVec Cand1Attrs;
8303     if (Cand1.Function->hasAttrs()) {
8304       Cand1Attrs = Cand1.Function->getAttrs();
8305       Cand1Attrs.erase(std::remove_if(Cand1Attrs.begin(), Cand1Attrs.end(),
8306                                       IsNotEnableIfAttr),
8307                        Cand1Attrs.end());
8308       std::reverse(Cand1Attrs.begin(), Cand1Attrs.end());
8309     }
8310 
8311     AttrVec Cand2Attrs;
8312     if (Cand2.Function->hasAttrs()) {
8313       Cand2Attrs = Cand2.Function->getAttrs();
8314       Cand2Attrs.erase(std::remove_if(Cand2Attrs.begin(), Cand2Attrs.end(),
8315                                       IsNotEnableIfAttr),
8316                        Cand2Attrs.end());
8317       std::reverse(Cand2Attrs.begin(), Cand2Attrs.end());
8318     }
8319 
8320     // Candidate 1 is better if it has strictly more attributes and
8321     // the common sequence is identical.
8322     if (Cand1Attrs.size() <= Cand2Attrs.size())
8323       return false;
8324 
8325     auto Cand1I = Cand1Attrs.begin();
8326     for (auto &Cand2A : Cand2Attrs) {
8327       auto &Cand1A = *Cand1I++;
8328       llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID;
8329       cast<EnableIfAttr>(Cand1A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID,
8330                                                      S.getASTContext(), true);
8331       cast<EnableIfAttr>(Cand2A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID,
8332                                                      S.getASTContext(), true);
8333       if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID)
8334         return false;
8335     }
8336 
8337     return true;
8338   }
8339 
8340   return false;
8341 }
8342 
8343 /// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
8344 /// within an overload candidate set.
8345 ///
8346 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
8347 /// which overload resolution occurs.
8348 ///
8349 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
8350 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
8351 ///
8352 /// \returns The result of overload resolution.
8353 OverloadingResult
8354 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
8355                                          iterator &Best,
8356                                          bool UserDefinedConversion) {
8357   // Find the best viable function.
8358   Best = end();
8359   for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
8360     if (Cand->Viable)
8361       if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
8362                                                      UserDefinedConversion))
8363         Best = Cand;
8364   }
8365 
8366   // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
8367   if (Best == end())
8368     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
8369 
8370   // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
8371   // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
8372   for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
8373     if (Cand->Viable &&
8374         Cand != Best &&
8375         !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
8376                                    UserDefinedConversion)) {
8377       Best = end();
8378       return OR_Ambiguous;
8379     }
8380   }
8381 
8382   // Best is the best viable function.
8383   if (Best->Function &&
8384       (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
8385        S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
8386     return OR_Deleted;
8387 
8388   return OR_Success;
8389 }
8390 
8391 namespace {
8392 
8393 enum OverloadCandidateKind {
8394   oc_function,
8395   oc_method,
8396   oc_constructor,
8397   oc_function_template,
8398   oc_method_template,
8399   oc_constructor_template,
8400   oc_implicit_default_constructor,
8401   oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
8402   oc_implicit_move_constructor,
8403   oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
8404   oc_implicit_move_assignment,
8405   oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
8406 };
8407 
8408 OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
8409                                                 FunctionDecl *Fn,
8410                                                 std::string &Description) {
8411   bool isTemplate = false;
8412 
8413   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
8414     isTemplate = true;
8415     Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8416       FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
8417   }
8418 
8419   if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
8420     if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
8421       return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
8422 
8423     if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
8424       return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
8425 
8426     if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
8427       return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
8428 
8429     if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
8430       return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
8431 
8432     assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
8433            "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
8434     return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
8435   }
8436 
8437   if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
8438     // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
8439     // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
8440     if (!Meth->isImplicit())
8441       return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
8442 
8443     if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
8444       return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
8445 
8446     if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
8447       return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
8448 
8449     assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
8450     return oc_method;
8451   }
8452 
8453   return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
8454 }
8455 
8456 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *Fn) {
8457   const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
8458   if (!Ctor) return;
8459 
8460   Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
8461   if (!Ctor) return;
8462 
8463   S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
8464 }
8465 
8466 } // end anonymous namespace
8467 
8468 // Notes the location of an overload candidate.
8469 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) {
8470   std::string FnDesc;
8471   OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
8472   PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
8473                              << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
8474   HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
8475   Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
8476   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
8477 }
8478 
8479 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
8480 // OverloadedExpr
8481 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) {
8482   assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
8483 
8484   OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
8485   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
8486 
8487   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
8488                             IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
8489        I != IEnd; ++I) {
8490     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
8491                 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
8492       NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType);
8493     } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
8494                       = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
8495       NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType);
8496     }
8497   }
8498 }
8499 
8500 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion.  The partial diagnostic is the
8501 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
8502 /// target types of the conversion.
8503 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
8504                                  Sema &S,
8505                                  SourceLocation CaretLoc,
8506                                  const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
8507   S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
8508     << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
8509   // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
8510   // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
8511   // refactoring here.
8512   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
8513   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
8514   AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
8515   for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8516     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
8517       break;
8518     ++CandsShown;
8519     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
8520   }
8521   if (I != E)
8522     S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
8523 }
8524 
8525 namespace {
8526 
8527 void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
8528   const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
8529   assert(Conv.isBad());
8530   assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
8531   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8532 
8533   // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
8534   // non-constructor method.  Note that 'I' corresponds the
8535   // conversion-slot index.
8536   bool isObjectArgument = false;
8537   if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
8538     if (I == 0)
8539       isObjectArgument = true;
8540     else
8541       I--;
8542   }
8543 
8544   std::string FnDesc;
8545   OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
8546 
8547   Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
8548   QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
8549   QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
8550 
8551   if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
8552     assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
8553     Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
8554     if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
8555       E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
8556     DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
8557 
8558     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
8559       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8560       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8561       << ToTy << Name << I+1;
8562     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8563     return;
8564   }
8565 
8566   // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
8567   // to a qualifier mismatch.
8568   CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
8569   CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
8570   if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8571     CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
8572   else {
8573     // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
8574     if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8575       if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8576         CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
8577   }
8578 
8579   if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
8580       !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
8581     Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8582     Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8583 
8584     if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
8585       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
8586         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8587         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8588         << FromTy
8589         << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
8590         << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8591       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8592       return;
8593     }
8594 
8595     if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
8596       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
8597         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8598         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8599         << FromTy
8600         << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
8601         << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8602       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8603       return;
8604     }
8605 
8606     if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
8607       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
8608       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8609       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8610       << FromTy
8611       << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
8612       << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8613       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8614       return;
8615     }
8616 
8617     unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
8618     assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
8619 
8620     if (isObjectArgument) {
8621       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
8622         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8623         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8624         << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
8625     } else {
8626       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
8627         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8628         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8629         << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
8630     }
8631     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8632     return;
8633   }
8634 
8635   // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
8636   // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
8637   if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
8638     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
8639       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8640       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8641       << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8642     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8643     return;
8644   }
8645 
8646   // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
8647   // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
8648   // the failure.
8649   QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
8650   if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8651     TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
8652   if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
8653     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
8654       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8655       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8656       << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8657     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8658     return;
8659   }
8660 
8661   // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
8662   unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
8663   if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8664     if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8665       if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8666                                                FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8667           !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8668           !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8669           S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
8670                           FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
8671         BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
8672     }
8673   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
8674                                     = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8675     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
8676                                         = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8677       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8678         if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8679           if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8680                                                 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8681               FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
8682             BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
8683   } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
8684     if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
8685         !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
8686         !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8687         S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
8688       BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
8689     } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() &&
8690                ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() ==
8691                FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) {
8692       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue)
8693         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8694         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8695         << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1;
8696       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8697       return;
8698     }
8699   }
8700 
8701   if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
8702     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
8703            diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
8704       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8705       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8706       << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
8707       << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
8708     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8709     return;
8710   }
8711 
8712   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
8713       isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
8714       Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8715       Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8716       if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
8717         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
8718         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8719         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8720         << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8721         MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8722         return;
8723       }
8724   }
8725 
8726   // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
8727   PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
8728   FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8729     << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8730     << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
8731     << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
8732 
8733   // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
8734   for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
8735        HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
8736     FDiag << *HI;
8737   S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
8738 
8739   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8740 }
8741 
8742 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload
8743 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch()
8744 /// over a candidate in any candidate set.
8745 bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8746                         unsigned NumArgs) {
8747   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8748   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
8749 
8750   // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
8751   // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the
8752   // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
8753   // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
8754   // Just don't report anything.
8755   if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
8756       Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
8757     return true;
8758 
8759   if (NumArgs < MinParams) {
8760     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
8761            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8762             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
8763   } else {
8764     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
8765            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8766             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
8767   }
8768 
8769   return false;
8770 }
8771 
8772 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set.
8773 void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, Decl *D, unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8774   assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
8775       "The templated declaration should at least be a function"
8776       " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many"
8777       " or too few arguments");
8778 
8779   FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
8780 
8781   // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
8782   const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8783   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
8784 
8785   // at least / at most / exactly
8786   unsigned mode, modeCount;
8787   if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
8788     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() ||
8789         FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
8790       mode = 0; // "at least"
8791     else
8792       mode = 2; // "exactly"
8793     modeCount = MinParams;
8794   } else {
8795     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams())
8796       mode = 1; // "at most"
8797     else
8798       mode = 2; // "exactly"
8799     modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams();
8800   }
8801 
8802   std::string Description;
8803   OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
8804 
8805   if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
8806     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
8807       << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != nullptr)
8808       << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
8809   else
8810     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
8811       << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != nullptr)
8812       << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
8813   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8814 }
8815 
8816 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate.
8817 void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8818                            unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8819   if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs))
8820     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs);
8821 }
8822 
8823 TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) {
8824   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated))
8825     return FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
8826   else if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Templated))
8827     return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate();
8828 
8829   llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration"
8830                    " for bad deduction diagnosis");
8831 }
8832 
8833 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
8834 void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, Decl *Templated,
8835                           DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure,
8836                           unsigned NumArgs) {
8837   TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
8838   NamedDecl *ParamD;
8839   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
8840   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
8841   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
8842   switch (DeductionFailure.Result) {
8843   case Sema::TDK_Success:
8844     llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
8845 
8846   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
8847     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
8848     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8849            diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
8850         << ParamD->getDeclName();
8851     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
8852     return;
8853   }
8854 
8855   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
8856     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
8857     TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
8858 
8859     QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
8860 
8861     // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
8862     // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
8863     QualifierCollector Qs;
8864     Qs.strip(Param);
8865     QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
8866     assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
8867 
8868     // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
8869     // about that.  It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
8870     // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
8871     // done on dependent types).
8872     QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
8873 
8874     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
8875         << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
8876     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
8877     return;
8878   }
8879 
8880   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
8881     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
8882     int which = 0;
8883     if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
8884       which = 0;
8885     else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
8886       which = 1;
8887     else {
8888       which = 2;
8889     }
8890 
8891     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8892            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
8893         << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8894         << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
8895     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
8896     return;
8897   }
8898 
8899   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
8900     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
8901     if (ParamD->getDeclName())
8902       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8903              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
8904           << ParamD->getDeclName();
8905     else {
8906       int index = 0;
8907       if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
8908         index = TTP->getIndex();
8909       else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
8910                                   = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
8911         index = NTTP->getIndex();
8912       else
8913         index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
8914       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8915              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
8916           << (index + 1);
8917     }
8918     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
8919     return;
8920 
8921   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8922   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8923     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Templated, NumArgs);
8924     return;
8925 
8926   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8927     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8928            diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
8929     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
8930     return;
8931 
8932   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
8933     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
8934     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
8935     if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
8936             DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
8937       TemplateArgString = " ";
8938       TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8939           getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
8940     }
8941 
8942     // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
8943     PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
8944     if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
8945           diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
8946       // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
8947       //        name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
8948       S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
8949         << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
8950       return;
8951     }
8952 
8953     // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
8954     // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
8955     //        formatted message in another diagnostic.
8956     SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
8957     SourceRange R;
8958     if (PDiag) {
8959       SFINAEArgString = ": ";
8960       R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
8961       PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
8962     }
8963 
8964     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8965            diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
8966         << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
8967     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
8968     return;
8969   }
8970 
8971   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: {
8972     OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(DeductionFailure.getExpr());
8973     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8974            diag::note_ovl_candidate_failed_overload_resolution)
8975         << R.Expression->getName();
8976     return;
8977   }
8978 
8979   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
8980     // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
8981     TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
8982     TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
8983     if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template &&
8984         SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) {
8985       TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate();
8986       TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate();
8987       if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template &&
8988           SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) {
8989         if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() ==
8990             SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) {
8991           // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named
8992           // the same.  This particular case is a bit difficult since:
8993           // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer.
8994           // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better
8995           //    name for types, not decls.
8996           // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer.
8997           S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8998                  diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified)
8999               << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl();
9000           return;
9001         }
9002       }
9003     }
9004     // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda
9005     // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative
9006     // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to
9007     // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters.
9008     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9009            diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
9010         << FirstTA << SecondTA;
9011     return;
9012   }
9013   // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
9014   // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
9015   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
9016     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
9017     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
9018     return;
9019   }
9020 }
9021 
9022 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls.
9023 void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned NumArgs) {
9024   unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result;
9025   if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) {
9026     if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs))
9027       return;
9028   }
9029   DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->Function, // pattern
9030                        Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs);
9031 }
9032 
9033 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
9034 void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9035   FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
9036   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
9037 
9038   Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
9039                            CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
9040 
9041   std::string FnDesc;
9042   OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
9043 
9044   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
9045       << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
9046 }
9047 
9048 void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9049   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
9050   EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data);
9051 
9052   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
9053          diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr)
9054       << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
9055 }
9056 
9057 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate.  We've
9058 /// already generated a primary error at the call site.
9059 ///
9060 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
9061 /// pointed at the candidate declaration.  Yes, this creates some
9062 /// major challenges of technical writing.  Yes, this makes pointing
9063 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward.  It's still
9064 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
9065 /// overload.
9066 ///
9067 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
9068 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
9069 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
9070 void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
9071                            unsigned NumArgs) {
9072   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
9073 
9074   // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
9075   if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
9076       S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
9077     std::string FnDesc;
9078     OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
9079 
9080     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
9081       << FnKind << FnDesc
9082       << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
9083     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
9084     return;
9085   }
9086 
9087   // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
9088   if (Cand->Viable) {
9089     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
9090     return;
9091   }
9092 
9093   switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
9094   case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
9095   case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
9096     return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
9097 
9098   case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
9099     return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs);
9100 
9101   case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
9102   case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
9103   case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
9104     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
9105 
9106   case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
9107     unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
9108     for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I)
9109       if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
9110         return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
9111 
9112     // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
9113     // when user-conversion overload fails.  Figure out how to handle
9114     // those conditions and diagnose them well.
9115     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
9116   }
9117 
9118   case ovl_fail_bad_target:
9119     return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
9120 
9121   case ovl_fail_enable_if:
9122     return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand);
9123   }
9124 }
9125 
9126 void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9127   // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
9128   // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
9129   // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
9130   QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
9131   bool isLValueReference = false;
9132   bool isRValueReference = false;
9133   bool isPointer = false;
9134   if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
9135         FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
9136     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
9137     isLValueReference = true;
9138   } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
9139                FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
9140     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
9141     isRValueReference = true;
9142   }
9143   if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
9144     FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9145     isPointer = true;
9146   }
9147   // Desugar down to a function type.
9148   FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
9149   // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
9150   if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
9151   if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
9152   if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
9153 
9154   S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
9155     << FnType;
9156   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
9157 }
9158 
9159 void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
9160                                   StringRef Opc,
9161                                   SourceLocation OpLoc,
9162                                   OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9163   assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
9164   std::string TypeStr("operator");
9165   TypeStr += Opc;
9166   TypeStr += "(";
9167   TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
9168   if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) {
9169     TypeStr += ")";
9170     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
9171   } else {
9172     TypeStr += ", ";
9173     TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
9174     TypeStr += ")";
9175     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
9176   }
9177 }
9178 
9179 void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
9180                                   OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9181   unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions;
9182   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
9183     const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
9184     if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
9185     if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
9186 
9187     ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
9188                               S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
9189   }
9190 }
9191 
9192 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9193   if (Cand->Function)
9194     return Cand->Function->getLocation();
9195   if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
9196     return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
9197   return SourceLocation();
9198 }
9199 
9200 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
9201   switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
9202   case Sema::TDK_Success:
9203     llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
9204 
9205   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
9206   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
9207     return 1;
9208 
9209   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
9210   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
9211     return 2;
9212 
9213   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
9214   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
9215   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
9216     return 3;
9217 
9218   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
9219   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
9220     return 4;
9221 
9222   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
9223     return 5;
9224 
9225   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
9226   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
9227     return 6;
9228   }
9229   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
9230 }
9231 
9232 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
9233   Sema &S;
9234   size_t NumArgs;
9235 
9236   CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S, size_t nArgs)
9237       : S(S), NumArgs(nArgs) {}
9238 
9239   bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
9240                   const OverloadCandidate *R) {
9241     // Fast-path this check.
9242     if (L == R) return false;
9243 
9244     // Order first by viability.
9245     if (L->Viable) {
9246       if (!R->Viable) return true;
9247 
9248       // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
9249       // candidates.  Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
9250       // that could exploit it.
9251       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
9252       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
9253     } else if (R->Viable)
9254       return false;
9255 
9256     assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
9257 
9258     // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
9259     if (!L->Viable) {
9260       // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
9261       if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
9262           L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
9263         if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
9264             R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
9265           int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
9266           int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
9267           if (LDist == RDist) {
9268             if (L->FailureKind == R->FailureKind)
9269               // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates.
9270               return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate;
9271             // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were
9272             // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters
9273             // than there were arguments given.
9274             return L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
9275           }
9276           return LDist < RDist;
9277         }
9278         return false;
9279       }
9280       if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
9281           R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
9282         return true;
9283 
9284       // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
9285       // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
9286       if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
9287         if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
9288           return true;
9289 
9290         // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
9291         // comes first.
9292         unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
9293         unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
9294         numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
9295         numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
9296         if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
9297           if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
9298             return true;
9299           else
9300             return false;
9301         }
9302 
9303         // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
9304         // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
9305         assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions);
9306 
9307         int leftBetter = 0;
9308         unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
9309         for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) {
9310           switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
9311                                                      L->Conversions[I],
9312                                                      R->Conversions[I])) {
9313           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
9314             leftBetter++;
9315             break;
9316 
9317           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
9318             leftBetter--;
9319             break;
9320 
9321           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
9322             break;
9323           }
9324         }
9325         if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
9326         if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
9327 
9328       } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
9329         return false;
9330 
9331       if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
9332         if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
9333           return true;
9334 
9335         if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
9336           return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
9337                < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
9338       } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
9339         return false;
9340 
9341       // TODO: others?
9342     }
9343 
9344     // Sort everything else by location.
9345     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
9346     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
9347 
9348     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
9349     if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
9350     if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
9351 
9352     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
9353   }
9354 };
9355 
9356 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
9357 /// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
9358 void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
9359                                 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
9360   assert(!Cand->Viable);
9361 
9362   // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
9363   if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
9364 
9365   // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
9366   bool Unfixable = false;
9367   // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
9368   Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
9369 
9370   // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
9371   unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
9372   unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions;
9373   while (true) {
9374     assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
9375     ConvIdx++;
9376     if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
9377       Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
9378       break;
9379     }
9380   }
9381 
9382   if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
9383     return;
9384 
9385   assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
9386          "remaining conversion is initialized?");
9387 
9388   // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
9389   // operation somehow.
9390   bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
9391 
9392   const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
9393   unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
9394 
9395   if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
9396     QualType ConvType
9397       = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
9398     if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
9399       ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
9400     Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9401     ArgIdx--;
9402   } else if (Cand->Function) {
9403     Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9404     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
9405         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
9406       ArgIdx--;
9407   } else {
9408     // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
9409     assert(ConvCount <= 3);
9410     for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
9411       Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
9412         = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
9413                                 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
9414                                 SuppressUserConversions,
9415                                 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
9416                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
9417                                   S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
9418     return;
9419   }
9420 
9421   // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
9422   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
9423   for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
9424     if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
9425       Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryCopyInitialization(
9426           S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx), SuppressUserConversions,
9427           /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
9428           /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
9429           S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
9430       // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
9431       if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
9432         Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
9433     }
9434     else
9435       Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
9436   }
9437 }
9438 
9439 } // end anonymous namespace
9440 
9441 /// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
9442 /// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
9443 /// set.
9444 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
9445                                           OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
9446                                           ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
9447                                           StringRef Opc,
9448                                           SourceLocation OpLoc) {
9449   // Sort the candidates by viability and position.  Sorting directly would
9450   // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
9451   SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
9452   if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
9453   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
9454     if (Cand->Viable)
9455       Cands.push_back(Cand);
9456     else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
9457       CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args);
9458       if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
9459         Cands.push_back(Cand);
9460       // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate.  We do not, in general,
9461       // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
9462     }
9463   }
9464 
9465   std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
9466             CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, Args.size()));
9467 
9468   bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
9469 
9470   SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
9471   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
9472   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
9473   for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9474     OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
9475 
9476     // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
9477     // the user with.  FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
9478     // candidate list.
9479     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
9480       break;
9481     }
9482     ++CandsShown;
9483 
9484     if (Cand->Function)
9485       NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size());
9486     else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
9487       NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
9488     else {
9489       assert(Cand->Viable &&
9490              "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
9491       // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
9492       // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
9493       // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
9494       //
9495       // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
9496       // different ambiguities, though.
9497       if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
9498         NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
9499         ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
9500       }
9501 
9502       // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
9503       NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
9504     }
9505   }
9506 
9507   if (I != E)
9508     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
9509 }
9510 
9511 static SourceLocation
9512 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) {
9513   return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation()
9514                               : SourceLocation();
9515 }
9516 
9517 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay {
9518   Sema &S;
9519   CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
9520 
9521   bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L,
9522                   const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) {
9523     // Fast-path this check.
9524     if (L == R)
9525       return false;
9526 
9527     // Assuming that both candidates are not matches...
9528 
9529     // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures.
9530     if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
9531       return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) <
9532              RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
9533 
9534     // Sort everything else by location.
9535     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
9536     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
9537 
9538     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
9539     if (LLoc.isInvalid())
9540       return false;
9541     if (RLoc.isInvalid())
9542       return true;
9543 
9544     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
9545   }
9546 };
9547 
9548 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure.
9549 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad
9550 /// deductions.
9551 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S) {
9552   DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Specialization, // pattern
9553                        DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0);
9554 }
9555 
9556 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
9557   for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
9558     i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
9559   }
9560 }
9561 
9562 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() {
9563   destroyCandidates();
9564   Candidates.clear();
9565 }
9566 
9567 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints
9568 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form
9569 /// the candidate set.
9570 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with
9571 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false.
9572 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
9573   // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match).
9574   // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers
9575   // and sort those.
9576   SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands;
9577   Cands.reserve(size());
9578   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
9579     if (Cand->Specialization)
9580       Cands.push_back(Cand);
9581     // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate.  We do not,
9582     // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate.
9583   }
9584 
9585   std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
9586             CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S));
9587 
9588   // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads()
9589   // for generalization purposes (?).
9590   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
9591 
9592   SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E;
9593   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
9594   for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9595     TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I;
9596 
9597     // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam
9598     // the user with.  FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
9599     // candidate list.
9600     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
9601       break;
9602     ++CandsShown;
9603 
9604     assert(Cand->Specialization &&
9605            "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
9606     Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S);
9607   }
9608 
9609   if (I != E)
9610     S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
9611 }
9612 
9613 // [PossiblyAFunctionType]  -->   [Return]
9614 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
9615 // R (A) --> R(A)
9616 // R (*)(A) --> R (A)
9617 // R (&)(A) --> R (A)
9618 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
9619 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
9620   QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
9621   if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
9622     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
9623     Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9624   else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
9625     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
9626     Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
9627   else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
9628     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
9629     Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9630   Ret =
9631     Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
9632   return Ret;
9633 }
9634 
9635 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution
9636 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
9637 class AddressOfFunctionResolver
9638 {
9639   Sema& S;
9640   Expr* SourceExpr;
9641   const QualType& TargetType;
9642   QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
9643 
9644   bool Complain;
9645   //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
9646   ASTContext& Context;
9647 
9648   bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
9649   bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
9650   bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
9651 
9652   OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
9653   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
9654   TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
9655   SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
9656   TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates;
9657 
9658 public:
9659   AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr,
9660                             const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain)
9661       : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
9662         Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
9663         TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
9664             !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
9665         FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
9666         StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false),
9667         OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
9668         OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression),
9669         FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc()) {
9670     ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
9671 
9672     if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
9673       if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr))
9674         if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() &&
9675             !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME))
9676           StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true;
9677     } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9678       DeclAccessPair dap;
9679       if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9680               OvlExpr, false, &dap)) {
9681         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn))
9682           if (!Method->isStatic()) {
9683             // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found
9684             // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the
9685             // target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
9686             TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
9687 
9688             // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
9689             // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
9690             if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
9691               return;
9692           }
9693 
9694         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn));
9695       }
9696       return;
9697     }
9698 
9699     if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
9700       OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
9701 
9702     if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
9703       // C++ [over.over]p4:
9704       //   If more than one function is selected, [...]
9705       if (Matches.size() > 1) {
9706         if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
9707           EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
9708         else
9709           EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
9710       }
9711     }
9712   }
9713 
9714 private:
9715   bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
9716     return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
9717   }
9718 
9719   // [ToType]     [Return]
9720 
9721   // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9722   // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9723   // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
9724   void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
9725     TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
9726   }
9727 
9728   // return true if any matching specializations were found
9729   bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
9730                                    const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
9731     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
9732               = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
9733       // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
9734       // static when converting to member pointer.
9735       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9736         return false;
9737     }
9738     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9739       return false;
9740 
9741     // C++ [over.over]p2:
9742     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9743     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9744     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9745     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9746     //   overloaded functions considered.
9747     FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
9748     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
9749     if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
9750           = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
9751                                       &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
9752                                       TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
9753                                       Info, /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) {
9754       // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9755       FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
9756           .set(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
9757                MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
9758       return false;
9759     }
9760 
9761     // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or
9762     // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS.
9763     // This function template specicalization works.
9764     Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
9765     assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType(
9766               Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()),
9767               Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType)));
9768     Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
9769     return true;
9770   }
9771 
9772   bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
9773                                       const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
9774     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
9775       // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
9776       // when converting to member pointer.
9777       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9778         return false;
9779     }
9780     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9781       return false;
9782 
9783     if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
9784       if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
9785         if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
9786           if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
9787             return false;
9788 
9789       // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction
9790       // now.
9791       if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y &&
9792           FunDecl->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
9793           S.DeduceReturnType(FunDecl, SourceExpr->getLocStart(), Complain))
9794         return false;
9795 
9796       QualType ResultTy;
9797       if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
9798                                          FunDecl->getType()) ||
9799           S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
9800                                  ResultTy)) {
9801         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
9802           cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
9803         FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
9804         return true;
9805       }
9806     }
9807 
9808     return false;
9809   }
9810 
9811   bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
9812     bool Ret = false;
9813 
9814     // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
9815     // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
9816     if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9817       return false;
9818 
9819     for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9820                                E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9821          I != E; ++I) {
9822       // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
9823       NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9824 
9825       // C++ [over.over]p3:
9826       //   Non-member functions and static member functions match
9827       //   targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
9828       //   Nonstatic member functions match targets of
9829       //   type "pointer-to-member-function."
9830       // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
9831       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9832                                         = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
9833         if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
9834           Ret = true;
9835       }
9836       // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
9837       else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
9838                AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
9839         Ret = true;
9840     }
9841     assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
9842     return Ret;
9843   }
9844 
9845   void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
9846     //   [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
9847     //   eliminated if the set contains a second function template
9848     //   specialization whose function template is more specialized
9849     //   than the function template of F1 according to the partial
9850     //   ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
9851 
9852     // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
9853     // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
9854     // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
9855     // best function template (if it exists).
9856 
9857     UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
9858     for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
9859       MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
9860 
9861     // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose
9862     // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0.
9863     UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized(
9864         MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates,
9865         SourceExpr->getLocStart(), S.PDiag(),
9866         S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) << Matches[0]
9867                                                      .second->getDeclName(),
9868         S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) << (unsigned)oc_function_template,
9869         Complain, TargetFunctionType);
9870 
9871     if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
9872       // Make it the first and only element
9873       Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
9874       Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
9875       Matches.resize(1);
9876     }
9877   }
9878 
9879   void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
9880     //   [...] any function template specializations in the set are
9881     //   eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
9882     for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
9883       if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr)
9884         ++I;
9885       else {
9886         Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
9887         Matches.set_size(N);
9888       }
9889     }
9890   }
9891 
9892 public:
9893   void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
9894     assert(Matches.empty());
9895     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
9896         << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
9897         << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
9898     if (FailedCandidates.empty())
9899       S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
9900     else {
9901       // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose
9902       // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates
9903       // normally.
9904       for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9905                                  IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9906            I != IEnd; ++I)
9907         if (FunctionDecl *Fun =
9908                 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
9909           S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, TargetFunctionType);
9910       FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getLocStart());
9911     }
9912   }
9913 
9914   bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9915     return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
9916       !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
9917   }
9918 
9919   void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9920       // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
9921       // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
9922       // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
9923       S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
9924         << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
9925   }
9926 
9927   bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
9928     return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
9929   }
9930 
9931   void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
9932     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(),
9933            diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
9934       << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
9935   }
9936 
9937   void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
9938     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
9939       << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
9940   }
9941 
9942   void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
9943     assert(Matches.size() > 1);
9944     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9945       << OvlExpr->getName()
9946       << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
9947     S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
9948   }
9949 
9950   bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
9951 
9952   int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
9953 
9954   FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
9955     if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
9956     return Matches[0].second;
9957   }
9958 
9959   const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
9960     if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
9961     return &Matches[0].first;
9962   }
9963 };
9964 
9965 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
9966 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
9967 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
9968 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
9969 ///
9970 /// @code
9971 /// int f(double);
9972 /// int f(int);
9973 ///
9974 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
9975 /// @endcode
9976 ///
9977 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
9978 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
9979 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
9980 FunctionDecl *
9981 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
9982                                          QualType TargetType,
9983                                          bool Complain,
9984                                          DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
9985                                          bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
9986   assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
9987 
9988   AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
9989                                      Complain);
9990   int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
9991   FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr;
9992   if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
9993     if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9994       Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
9995     else
9996       Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
9997   }
9998   else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
9999     Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
10000   else if (NumMatches == 1) {
10001     Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
10002     assert(Fn);
10003     FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
10004     if (Complain) {
10005       if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer())
10006         Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer();
10007       else
10008         CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
10009     }
10010   }
10011 
10012   if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
10013     *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
10014   return Fn;
10015 }
10016 
10017 /// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
10018 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
10019 ///
10020 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
10021 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
10022 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
10023 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
10024 ///
10025 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is
10026 /// returned.
10027 FunctionDecl *
10028 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
10029                                                   bool Complain,
10030                                                   DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
10031   // C++ [over.over]p1:
10032   //   [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
10033   //   overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
10034   // C++ [over.over]p1:
10035   //   [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
10036   //   operator.
10037 
10038   // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
10039   if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
10040     return nullptr;
10041 
10042   TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
10043   ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
10044   TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc());
10045 
10046   // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
10047   // whose type matches exactly.
10048   FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr;
10049   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
10050          E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10051     // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
10052     //   [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
10053     //   where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
10054     //   specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
10055     //   identifies a single function template specialization, then the
10056     //   template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
10057     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
10058       = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
10059 
10060     // C++ [over.over]p2:
10061     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
10062     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
10063     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
10064     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
10065     //   overloaded functions considered.
10066     FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
10067     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
10068     if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
10069           = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
10070                                     Specialization, Info,
10071                                     /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) {
10072       // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
10073       // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info?
10074       FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
10075           .set(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
10076                MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
10077       continue;
10078     }
10079 
10080     assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
10081 
10082     // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
10083     if (Matched) {
10084       if (Complain) {
10085         Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
10086           << ovl->getName();
10087         NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
10088       }
10089       return nullptr;
10090     }
10091 
10092     Matched = Specialization;
10093     if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
10094   }
10095 
10096   if (Matched && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y &&
10097       Matched->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
10098       DeduceReturnType(Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain))
10099     return nullptr;
10100 
10101   return Matched;
10102 }
10103 
10104 
10105 
10106 
10107 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
10108 // because it identifies a single function template specialization.
10109 //
10110 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
10111 //
10112 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
10113 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded.  Always
10114 // returns true if 'complain' is set.
10115 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
10116                       ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
10117                    bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
10118                                            QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
10119                                             unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
10120   assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10121 
10122   OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
10123 
10124   DeclAccessPair found;
10125   ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
10126   if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
10127                            ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
10128     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) {
10129       SrcExpr = ExprError();
10130       return true;
10131     }
10132 
10133     // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
10134     // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
10135     // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
10136     // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
10137     if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
10138         isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
10139         cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
10140       if (!complain) return false;
10141 
10142       Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
10143            diag::err_bound_member_function)
10144         << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
10145 
10146       // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
10147       // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
10148       // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
10149       // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
10150       // the static candidates were rejected.
10151       SrcExpr = ExprError();
10152       return true;
10153     }
10154 
10155     // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
10156     SingleFunctionExpression =
10157         FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn);
10158 
10159     // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
10160     if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
10161       SingleFunctionExpression =
10162         DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get());
10163       if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
10164         SrcExpr = ExprError();
10165         return true;
10166       }
10167     }
10168   }
10169 
10170   if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
10171     if (complain) {
10172       Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
10173         << ovl.Expression->getName()
10174         << DestTypeForComplaining
10175         << OpRangeForComplaining
10176         << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
10177       NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
10178 
10179       SrcExpr = ExprError();
10180       return true;
10181     }
10182 
10183     return false;
10184   }
10185 
10186   SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
10187   return true;
10188 }
10189 
10190 /// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
10191 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
10192                                        DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
10193                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
10194                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10195                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10196                                        bool PartialOverloading,
10197                                        bool KnownValid) {
10198   NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
10199   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
10200     Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
10201 
10202   if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
10203     if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
10204       assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
10205       return;
10206     }
10207     S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
10208                            PartialOverloading);
10209     return;
10210   }
10211 
10212   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
10213       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
10214     S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
10215                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet);
10216     return;
10217   }
10218 
10219   assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
10220 }
10221 
10222 /// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
10223 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
10224 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10225                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10226                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10227                                        bool PartialOverloading) {
10228 
10229 #ifndef NDEBUG
10230   // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
10231   // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
10232   //
10233   //   Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
10234   //   and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
10235   //   lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
10236   //
10237   //     -- a declaration of a class member, or
10238   //
10239   //     -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
10240   //        using-declaration, or
10241   //
10242   //     -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
10243   //        template
10244   //
10245   //   then Y is empty.
10246 
10247   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
10248     for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
10249            E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10250       assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
10251       assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
10252              !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
10253       assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
10254     }
10255   }
10256 #endif
10257 
10258   // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
10259   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
10260   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
10261   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10262     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
10263     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
10264   }
10265 
10266   for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
10267          E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
10268     AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
10269                                CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
10270                                /*KnownValid*/ true);
10271 
10272   if (ULE->requiresADL())
10273     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(),
10274                                          Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
10275                                          CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
10276 }
10277 
10278 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into
10279 /// a different namespace.
10280 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) {
10281   switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) {
10282   case OO_New: case OO_Array_New:
10283   case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete:
10284     return false;
10285 
10286   default:
10287     return true;
10288   }
10289 }
10290 
10291 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
10292 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
10293 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
10294 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
10295 ///
10296 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
10297 static bool
10298 DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
10299                        const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
10300                        OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK,
10301                        TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
10302                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
10303   if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
10304     return false;
10305 
10306   for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
10307     if (DC->isTransparentContext())
10308       continue;
10309 
10310     SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
10311 
10312     if (!R.empty()) {
10313       R.suppressDiagnostics();
10314 
10315       if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
10316         // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
10317         // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
10318         R.clear();
10319         return false;
10320       }
10321 
10322       OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK);
10323       for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
10324         AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
10325                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
10326                                    Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
10327 
10328       OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
10329       if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
10330         // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
10331         // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
10332         R.clear();
10333         return false;
10334       }
10335 
10336       // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
10337       // declaring the function there instead.
10338       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
10339       Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
10340       SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
10341                                                  AssociatedNamespaces,
10342                                                  AssociatedClasses);
10343       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
10344       if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) {
10345         DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
10346         for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
10347                it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
10348                end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
10349           // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
10350           if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
10351             continue;
10352 
10353           // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a
10354           // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx.
10355           NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
10356           if (NS &&
10357               NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
10358             continue;
10359 
10360           SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
10361         }
10362       }
10363 
10364       SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10365         << R.getLookupName();
10366       if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
10367         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10368                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10369           << R.getLookupName() << 0;
10370       } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
10371         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10372                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10373           << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
10374       } else {
10375         // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
10376         // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
10377         // a localized representation of a list of items.
10378         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10379                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10380           << R.getLookupName() << 2;
10381       }
10382 
10383       // Try to recover by calling this function.
10384       return true;
10385     }
10386 
10387     R.clear();
10388   }
10389 
10390   return false;
10391 }
10392 
10393 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
10394 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
10395 /// was defined.
10396 ///
10397 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
10398 static bool
10399 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
10400                                SourceLocation OpLoc,
10401                                ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
10402   DeclarationName OpName =
10403     SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10404   LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
10405   return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
10406                                 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator,
10407                                 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args);
10408 }
10409 
10410 namespace {
10411 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
10412   Sema &SemaRef;
10413 public:
10414   BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
10415     assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
10416     SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
10417   }
10418 
10419   ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
10420     SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
10421   }
10422 };
10423 
10424 }
10425 
10426 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
10427 ///
10428 /// Returns true if new candidates were found.
10429 static ExprResult
10430 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10431                       UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10432                       SourceLocation LParenLoc,
10433                       MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10434                       SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10435                       bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
10436   // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
10437   // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
10438   //
10439   // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
10440   // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
10441   //
10442   if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
10443     return ExprError();
10444   BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
10445 
10446   CXXScopeSpec SS;
10447   SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
10448   SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
10449 
10450   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
10451   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
10452   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10453     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
10454     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
10455   }
10456 
10457   LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
10458                  Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
10459   FunctionCallFilterCCC Validator(SemaRef, Args.size(),
10460                                   ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr,
10461                                   dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn));
10462   NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll;
10463   CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ?
10464       (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator :
10465       (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll;
10466   if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
10467                               OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal,
10468                               ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args) &&
10469       (!EmptyLookup ||
10470        SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC,
10471                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args)))
10472     return ExprError();
10473 
10474   assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
10475 
10476   // Build an implicit member call if appropriate.  Just drop the
10477   // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
10478   ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
10479   if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
10480     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
10481                                                     R, ExplicitTemplateArgs);
10482   else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
10483     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
10484                                         ExplicitTemplateArgs);
10485   else
10486     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
10487 
10488   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
10489     return ExprError();
10490 
10491   // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
10492   // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
10493   // end up here.
10494   return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc,
10495                                MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
10496                                RParenLoc);
10497 }
10498 
10499 /// \brief Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
10500 /// the given function.
10501 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
10502 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10503                                   UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10504                                   MultiExprArg Args,
10505                                   SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10506                                   OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
10507                                   ExprResult *Result) {
10508 #ifndef NDEBUG
10509   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
10510     // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
10511     assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
10512 
10513     // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
10514     // Verify that this was correctly set up.
10515     FunctionDecl *F;
10516     if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
10517         (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
10518         F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
10519       llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
10520 
10521     // We don't perform ADL in C.
10522     assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
10523   }
10524 #endif
10525 
10526   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10527   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) {
10528     *Result = ExprError();
10529     return true;
10530   }
10531 
10532   // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
10533   // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
10534   AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet);
10535 
10536   // If we found nothing, try to recover.
10537   // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
10538   // out if it fails.
10539   if (CandidateSet->empty()) {
10540     // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
10541     // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
10542     // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
10543     // classes.
10544     if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
10545         (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
10546       CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args,
10547                                             Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
10548                                             RParenLoc);
10549       CE->setTypeDependent(true);
10550       *Result = CE;
10551       return true;
10552     }
10553     return false;
10554   }
10555 
10556   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10557   return false;
10558 }
10559 
10560 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
10561 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
10562 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
10563 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10564                                            UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10565                                            SourceLocation LParenLoc,
10566                                            MultiExprArg Args,
10567                                            SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10568                                            Expr *ExecConfig,
10569                                            OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
10570                                            OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
10571                                            OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
10572                                            bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
10573   if (CandidateSet->empty())
10574     return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
10575                                  RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
10576                                  AllowTypoCorrection);
10577 
10578   switch (OverloadResult) {
10579   case OR_Success: {
10580     FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
10581     SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
10582     if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc()))
10583       return ExprError();
10584     Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
10585     return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
10586                                          ExecConfig);
10587   }
10588 
10589   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
10590     // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
10591     // have meant to call.
10592     ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
10593                                                 Args, RParenLoc,
10594                                                 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
10595                                                 AllowTypoCorrection);
10596     if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
10597       return Recovery;
10598 
10599     SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
10600          diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
10601       << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
10602     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
10603     break;
10604   }
10605 
10606   case OR_Ambiguous:
10607     SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
10608       << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
10609     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
10610     break;
10611 
10612   case OR_Deleted: {
10613     SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
10614       << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted()
10615       << ULE->getName()
10616       << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function)
10617       << Fn->getSourceRange();
10618     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
10619 
10620     // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep
10621     // the call in the AST.
10622     FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
10623     Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
10624     return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
10625                                          ExecConfig);
10626   }
10627   }
10628 
10629   // Overload resolution failed.
10630   return ExprError();
10631 }
10632 
10633 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
10634 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
10635 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
10636 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
10637 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
10638 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
10639 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10640                                          UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10641                                          SourceLocation LParenLoc,
10642                                          MultiExprArg Args,
10643                                          SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10644                                          Expr *ExecConfig,
10645                                          bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
10646   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(),
10647                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
10648   ExprResult result;
10649 
10650   if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet,
10651                              &result))
10652     return result;
10653 
10654   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
10655   OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
10656       CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
10657 
10658   return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
10659                                   RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet,
10660                                   &Best, OverloadResult,
10661                                   AllowTypoCorrection);
10662 }
10663 
10664 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
10665   return Functions.size() > 1 ||
10666     (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
10667 }
10668 
10669 /// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10670 /// operator.
10671 ///
10672 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
10673 ///
10674 /// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10675 /// operator.
10676 ///
10677 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
10678 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10679 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10680 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10681 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10682 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
10683 ///
10684 /// \param Input The input argument.
10685 ExprResult
10686 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
10687                               const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
10688                               Expr *Input) {
10689   UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
10690 
10691   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10692   assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
10693   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10694   // TODO: provide better source location info.
10695   DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
10696 
10697   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
10698     return ExprError();
10699 
10700   Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr };
10701   unsigned NumArgs = 1;
10702 
10703   // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
10704   // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
10705   // post-decrement.
10706   if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
10707     llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
10708     Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
10709                                      SourceLocation());
10710     NumArgs = 2;
10711   }
10712 
10713   ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs);
10714 
10715   if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
10716     if (Fns.empty())
10717       return new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy,
10718                                          VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc);
10719 
10720     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
10721     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
10722       = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
10723                                      NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
10724                                      /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
10725                                      Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
10726     return new (Context)
10727         CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, ArgsArray, Context.DependentTy,
10728                             VK_RValue, OpLoc, false);
10729   }
10730 
10731   // Build an empty overload set.
10732   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
10733 
10734   // Add the candidates from the given function set.
10735   AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet, false);
10736 
10737   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10738   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
10739 
10740   // Add candidates from ADL.
10741   AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray,
10742                                        /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr,
10743                                        CandidateSet);
10744 
10745   // Add builtin operator candidates.
10746   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
10747 
10748   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10749 
10750   // Perform overload resolution.
10751   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
10752   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
10753   case OR_Success: {
10754     // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10755     FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10756 
10757     if (FnDecl) {
10758       // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10759       // operator.
10760 
10761       // Convert the arguments.
10762       if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
10763         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
10764 
10765         ExprResult InputRes =
10766           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
10767                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10768         if (InputRes.isInvalid())
10769           return ExprError();
10770         Input = InputRes.get();
10771       } else {
10772         // Convert the arguments.
10773         ExprResult InputInit
10774           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
10775                                                       Context,
10776                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10777                                       SourceLocation(),
10778                                       Input);
10779         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
10780           return ExprError();
10781         Input = InputInit.get();
10782       }
10783 
10784       // Build the actual expression node.
10785       ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
10786                                                 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
10787       if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10788         return ExprError();
10789 
10790       // Determine the result type.
10791       QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
10792       ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10793       ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10794 
10795       Args[0] = Input;
10796       CallExpr *TheCall =
10797         new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray,
10798                                           ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
10799 
10800       if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
10801         return ExprError();
10802 
10803       return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
10804     } else {
10805       // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10806       // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10807       // operator node.
10808       ExprResult InputRes =
10809         PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10810                                   Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10811       if (InputRes.isInvalid())
10812         return ExprError();
10813       Input = InputRes.get();
10814       break;
10815     }
10816   }
10817 
10818   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
10819     // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10820     // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10821     // defined too late to be candidates.
10822     if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray))
10823       // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10824       return ExprError();
10825 
10826     // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
10827     // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
10828     break;
10829 
10830   case OR_Ambiguous:
10831     Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
10832         << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10833         << Input->getType()
10834         << Input->getSourceRange();
10835     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, ArgsArray,
10836                                 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
10837     return ExprError();
10838 
10839   case OR_Deleted:
10840     Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10841       << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10842       << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10843       << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10844       << Input->getSourceRange();
10845     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray,
10846                                 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
10847     return ExprError();
10848   }
10849 
10850   // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
10851   // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
10852   // build a built-in operation.
10853   return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
10854 }
10855 
10856 /// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10857 /// operator.
10858 ///
10859 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
10860 ///
10861 /// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10862 /// operator.
10863 ///
10864 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
10865 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10866 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10867 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10868 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10869 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
10870 ///
10871 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
10872 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
10873 ExprResult
10874 Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
10875                             unsigned OpcIn,
10876                             const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
10877                             Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
10878   Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
10879   LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
10880 
10881   BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
10882   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10883   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10884 
10885   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10886   // expression.
10887   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
10888     if (Fns.empty()) {
10889       // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
10890       // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
10891       if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
10892         return new (Context) BinaryOperator(
10893             Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
10894             OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract);
10895 
10896       return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(
10897           Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary,
10898           Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, OpLoc,
10899           FPFeatures.fp_contract);
10900     }
10901 
10902     // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
10903     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
10904     // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
10905     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
10906     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
10907       = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
10908                                      NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
10909                                      /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
10910                                      Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
10911     return new (Context)
10912         CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy,
10913                             VK_RValue, OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract);
10914   }
10915 
10916   // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
10917   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10918     return ExprError();
10919 
10920   // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
10921   // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
10922   assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
10923   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10924     return ExprError();
10925 
10926   // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
10927   // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
10928   // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
10929   // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
10930   // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
10931   // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
10932   if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
10933     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
10934 
10935   // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
10936   // create a built-in binary operator.
10937   if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
10938     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
10939 
10940   // Build an empty overload set.
10941   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
10942 
10943   // Add the candidates from the given function set.
10944   AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet, false);
10945 
10946   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10947   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
10948 
10949   // Add candidates from ADL.
10950   AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args,
10951                                        /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr,
10952                                        CandidateSet);
10953 
10954   // Add builtin operator candidates.
10955   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
10956 
10957   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10958 
10959   // Perform overload resolution.
10960   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
10961   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
10962     case OR_Success: {
10963       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10964       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10965 
10966       if (FnDecl) {
10967         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10968         // operator.
10969 
10970         // Convert the arguments.
10971         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
10972           // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
10973           CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
10974 
10975           ExprResult Arg1 =
10976             PerformCopyInitialization(
10977               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10978                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10979               SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
10980           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
10981             return ExprError();
10982 
10983           ExprResult Arg0 =
10984             PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
10985                                                 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10986           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
10987             return ExprError();
10988           Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
10989           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
10990         } else {
10991           // Convert the arguments.
10992           ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
10993             InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10994                                                    FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10995             SourceLocation(), Args[0]);
10996           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
10997             return ExprError();
10998 
10999           ExprResult Arg1 =
11000             PerformCopyInitialization(
11001               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
11002                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
11003               SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
11004           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
11005             return ExprError();
11006           Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
11007           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
11008         }
11009 
11010         // Build the actual expression node.
11011         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
11012                                                   Best->FoundDecl,
11013                                                   HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
11014         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11015           return ExprError();
11016 
11017         // Determine the result type.
11018         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
11019         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11020         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11021 
11022         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
11023           new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(),
11024                                             Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
11025                                             FPFeatures.fp_contract);
11026 
11027         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
11028                                 FnDecl))
11029           return ExprError();
11030 
11031         ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
11032         // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
11033         if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl))
11034           ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
11035         checkCall(FnDecl, ArgsArray, 0, isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc,
11036                   TheCall->getSourceRange(), VariadicDoesNotApply);
11037 
11038         return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
11039       } else {
11040         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
11041         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
11042         // operator node.
11043         ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
11044           PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
11045                                     Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
11046         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
11047           return ExprError();
11048         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
11049 
11050         ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
11051           PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
11052                                     Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
11053         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
11054           return ExprError();
11055         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
11056         break;
11057       }
11058     }
11059 
11060     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
11061       // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
11062       //   If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
11063       //   viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
11064       //   built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
11065       if (Opc == BO_Comma)
11066         break;
11067 
11068       // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
11069       // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
11070       // no overloaded assignment operator found
11071       ExprResult Result = ExprError();
11072       if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
11073           Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
11074         Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
11075              << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
11076              << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11077         if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) {
11078           Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete)
11079             << Args[0]->getType()
11080             << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11081         }
11082       } else {
11083         // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
11084         // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
11085         // defined too late to be candidates.
11086         if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
11087           // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
11088           return ExprError();
11089 
11090         // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
11091         // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
11092         Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
11093       }
11094       assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
11095              "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
11096       if (Result.isInvalid())
11097         CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
11098                                     BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
11099       return Result;
11100     }
11101 
11102     case OR_Ambiguous:
11103       Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
11104           << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
11105           << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
11106           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11107       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
11108                                   BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
11109       return ExprError();
11110 
11111     case OR_Deleted:
11112       if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
11113         CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
11114         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
11115           << Context.getRecordType(Method->getParent())
11116           << getSpecialMember(Method);
11117 
11118         // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
11119         // explain why it's deleted.
11120         NoteDeletedFunction(Method);
11121         return ExprError();
11122       } else {
11123         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11124           << Best->Function->isDeleted()
11125           << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
11126           << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
11127           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11128       }
11129       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
11130                                   BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
11131       return ExprError();
11132   }
11133 
11134   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
11135   return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
11136 }
11137 
11138 ExprResult
11139 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
11140                                          SourceLocation RLoc,
11141                                          Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
11142   Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
11143   DeclarationName OpName =
11144       Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
11145 
11146   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
11147   // expression.
11148   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
11149 
11150     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
11151     // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
11152     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
11153     OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
11154     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
11155       = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
11156                                      NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
11157                                      /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
11158                                      UnresolvedSetIterator(),
11159                                      UnresolvedSetIterator());
11160     // Can't add any actual overloads yet
11161 
11162     return new (Context)
11163         CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn, Args,
11164                             Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc, false);
11165   }
11166 
11167   // Handle placeholders on both operands.
11168   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
11169     return ExprError();
11170   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
11171     return ExprError();
11172 
11173   // Build an empty overload set.
11174   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
11175 
11176   // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
11177 
11178   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
11179   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
11180 
11181   // Add builtin operator candidates.
11182   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
11183 
11184   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11185 
11186   // Perform overload resolution.
11187   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11188   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
11189     case OR_Success: {
11190       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
11191       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
11192 
11193       if (FnDecl) {
11194         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
11195         // operator.
11196 
11197         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
11198 
11199         // Convert the arguments.
11200         CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
11201         ExprResult Arg0 =
11202           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
11203                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11204         if (Arg0.isInvalid())
11205           return ExprError();
11206         Args[0] = Arg0.get();
11207 
11208         // Convert the arguments.
11209         ExprResult InputInit
11210           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
11211                                                       Context,
11212                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
11213                                       SourceLocation(),
11214                                       Args[1]);
11215         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
11216           return ExprError();
11217 
11218         Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
11219 
11220         // Build the actual expression node.
11221         DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
11222         OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
11223         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
11224                                                   Best->FoundDecl,
11225                                                   HadMultipleCandidates,
11226                                                   OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
11227                                                   OpLocInfo.getInfo());
11228         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11229           return ExprError();
11230 
11231         // Determine the result type
11232         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
11233         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11234         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11235 
11236         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
11237           new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
11238                                             FnExpr.get(), Args,
11239                                             ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
11240                                             false);
11241 
11242         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
11243           return ExprError();
11244 
11245         return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
11246       } else {
11247         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
11248         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
11249         // operator node.
11250         ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
11251           PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
11252                                     Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
11253         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
11254           return ExprError();
11255         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
11256 
11257         ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
11258           PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
11259                                     Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
11260         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
11261           return ExprError();
11262         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
11263 
11264         break;
11265       }
11266     }
11267 
11268     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
11269       if (CandidateSet.empty())
11270         Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
11271           << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
11272           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11273       else
11274         Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
11275           << Args[0]->getType()
11276           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11277       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
11278                                   "[]", LLoc);
11279       return ExprError();
11280     }
11281 
11282     case OR_Ambiguous:
11283       Diag(LLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
11284           << "[]"
11285           << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
11286           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11287       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
11288                                   "[]", LLoc);
11289       return ExprError();
11290 
11291     case OR_Deleted:
11292       Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11293         << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
11294         << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
11295         << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11296       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
11297                                   "[]", LLoc);
11298       return ExprError();
11299     }
11300 
11301   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
11302   return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
11303 }
11304 
11305 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
11306 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
11307 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
11308 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object
11309 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
11310 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
11311 /// member function.
11312 ExprResult
11313 Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
11314                                 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
11315                                 MultiExprArg Args,
11316                                 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
11317   assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
11318          MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
11319 
11320   // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
11321   // argument and the member function we're referring to.
11322   Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
11323 
11324   // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
11325   if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
11326     assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
11327     assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
11328 
11329     QualType fnType =
11330       op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11331 
11332     const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11333     QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
11334     ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType());
11335 
11336     // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
11337     // member function we're calling.
11338     Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
11339 
11340     QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
11341     if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
11342       objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11343     Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
11344 
11345     Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
11346     difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
11347     difference.removeAddressSpace();
11348     if (difference) {
11349       std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
11350       Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
11351         << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
11352         << qualsString
11353         << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
11354     }
11355 
11356     if (resultType->isMemberPointerType())
11357       if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
11358         RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, resultType, 0);
11359 
11360     CXXMemberCallExpr *call
11361       = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
11362                                         resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
11363 
11364     if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getLocStart(),
11365                             call, nullptr))
11366       return ExprError();
11367 
11368     if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc))
11369       return ExprError();
11370 
11371     if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto))
11372       return ExprError();
11373 
11374     return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
11375   }
11376 
11377   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
11378   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
11379     return ExprError();
11380 
11381   MemberExpr *MemExpr;
11382   CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr;
11383   DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public);
11384   NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr;
11385   if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
11386     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
11387     Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
11388     FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
11389     Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
11390     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11391   } else {
11392     UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
11393     Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
11394 
11395     QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
11396     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
11397       = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
11398                             : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
11399 
11400     // Add overload candidates
11401     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11402                                       OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
11403 
11404     // FIXME: avoid copy.
11405     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
11406     if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11407       UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11408       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
11409     }
11410 
11411     for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
11412            E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
11413 
11414       NamedDecl *Func = *I;
11415       CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
11416       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
11417         Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
11418 
11419 
11420       // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
11421       if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
11422         AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(),
11423                              Args, CandidateSet);
11424       } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
11425         // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
11426         // non-template member function.
11427         if (TemplateArgs)
11428           continue;
11429 
11430         AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
11431                            ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
11432                            /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
11433       } else {
11434         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
11435                                    I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
11436                                    ObjectType,  ObjectClassification,
11437                                    Args, CandidateSet,
11438                                    /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
11439       }
11440     }
11441 
11442     DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
11443 
11444     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11445 
11446     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11447     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
11448                                             Best)) {
11449     case OR_Success:
11450       Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
11451       FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
11452       CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
11453       if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
11454         return ExprError();
11455       // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template
11456       // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
11457       // called on both.
11458       // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
11459       // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
11460       // being used.
11461       if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
11462                       DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
11463         return ExprError();
11464       break;
11465 
11466     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11467       Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11468            diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
11469         << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
11470       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11471       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
11472       return ExprError();
11473 
11474     case OR_Ambiguous:
11475       Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
11476         << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
11477       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11478       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
11479       return ExprError();
11480 
11481     case OR_Deleted:
11482       Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
11483         << Best->Function->isDeleted()
11484         << DeclName
11485         << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
11486         << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
11487       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11488       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
11489       return ExprError();
11490     }
11491 
11492     MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
11493 
11494     // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
11495     // non-member call based on that function.
11496     if (Method->isStatic()) {
11497       return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args,
11498                                    RParenLoc);
11499     }
11500 
11501     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
11502   }
11503 
11504   QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType();
11505   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
11506   ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11507 
11508   assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
11509   CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
11510     new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
11511                                     ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
11512 
11513   // Check for a valid return type.
11514   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11515                           TheCall, Method))
11516     return ExprError();
11517 
11518   // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
11519   // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
11520   // it was done at lookup.
11521   if (!Method->isStatic()) {
11522     ExprResult ObjectArg =
11523       PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
11524                                           FoundDecl, Method);
11525     if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
11526       return ExprError();
11527     MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get());
11528   }
11529 
11530   // Convert the rest of the arguments
11531   const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11532     Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11533   if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args,
11534                               RParenLoc))
11535     return ExprError();
11536 
11537   DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
11538 
11539   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
11540     return ExprError();
11541 
11542   if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
11543        isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
11544       TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
11545     const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
11546 
11547     if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
11548       Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
11549            diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
11550         << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
11551         << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
11552 
11553       Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
11554     }
11555   }
11556   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
11557 }
11558 
11559 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
11560 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
11561 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
11562 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
11563 ExprResult
11564 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
11565                                    SourceLocation LParenLoc,
11566                                    MultiExprArg Args,
11567                                    SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
11568   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
11569     return ExprError();
11570   ExprResult Object = Obj;
11571 
11572   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
11573   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
11574     return ExprError();
11575 
11576   assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
11577   const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
11578 
11579   // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
11580   //  If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
11581   //  evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
11582   //  candidate functions includes at least the function call
11583   //  operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
11584   //  ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
11585   //  (E).operator().
11586   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc,
11587                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
11588   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
11589 
11590   if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
11591                           diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
11592     return true;
11593 
11594   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11595   LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
11596   R.suppressDiagnostics();
11597 
11598   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
11599        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
11600     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
11601                        Object.get()->Classify(Context),
11602                        Args, CandidateSet,
11603                        /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
11604   }
11605 
11606   // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
11607   //   In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
11608   //   declared in T of the form
11609   //
11610   //        operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
11611   //
11612   //   where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
11613   //   greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
11614   //   denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
11615   //   R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
11616   //   (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
11617   //   of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
11618   //   is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
11619   //   surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
11620   //   functions for each conversion function declared in an
11621   //   accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
11622   //   within T by another intervening declaration.
11623   std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
11624             CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions
11625     = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
11626   for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
11627          I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
11628     NamedDecl *D = *I;
11629     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
11630     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
11631       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
11632 
11633     // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
11634     // surrogates.
11635     if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
11636       continue;
11637 
11638     CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
11639     if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
11640       // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
11641       // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
11642       QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
11643       if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
11644         ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
11645 
11646       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
11647       {
11648         AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
11649                               Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet);
11650       }
11651     }
11652   }
11653 
11654   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11655 
11656   // Perform overload resolution.
11657   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11658   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
11659                              Best)) {
11660   case OR_Success:
11661     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
11662     // below.
11663     break;
11664 
11665   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11666     if (CandidateSet.empty())
11667       Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
11668         << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
11669         << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
11670     else
11671       Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
11672            diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
11673         << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
11674     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11675     break;
11676 
11677   case OR_Ambiguous:
11678     Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
11679          diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
11680       << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
11681     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
11682     break;
11683 
11684   case OR_Deleted:
11685     Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
11686          diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
11687       << Best->Function->isDeleted()
11688       << Object.get()->getType()
11689       << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
11690       << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
11691     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11692     break;
11693   }
11694 
11695   if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
11696     return true;
11697 
11698   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11699 
11700   if (Best->Function == nullptr) {
11701     // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
11702     // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
11703     CXXConversionDecl *Conv
11704       = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
11705                          Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
11706 
11707     CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr,
11708                               Best->FoundDecl);
11709     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc))
11710       return ExprError();
11711     assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
11712              "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!");
11713     // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
11714     // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
11715     // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
11716 
11717     // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
11718     // and then call it.
11719     ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
11720                                              Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
11721     if (Call.isInvalid())
11722       return ExprError();
11723     // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
11724     Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
11725                                     CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(),
11726                                     nullptr, VK_RValue);
11727 
11728     return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc);
11729   }
11730 
11731   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
11732 
11733   // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
11734   // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
11735   // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
11736   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
11737 
11738   // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
11739   if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
11740     return ExprError();
11741 
11742   const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11743     Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11744 
11745   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
11746 
11747   DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
11748                Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
11749   OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
11750   ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
11751                                            HadMultipleCandidates,
11752                                            OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
11753                                            OpLocInfo.getInfo());
11754   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
11755     return true;
11756 
11757   // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object
11758   // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list).
11759   std::unique_ptr<Expr * []> MethodArgs(new Expr *[Args.size() + 1]);
11760   MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
11761   std::copy(Args.begin(), Args.end(), &MethodArgs[1]);
11762 
11763   // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
11764   // owned.
11765   QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
11766   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11767   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11768 
11769   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = new (Context)
11770       CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(),
11771                           llvm::makeArrayRef(MethodArgs.get(), Args.size() + 1),
11772                           ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, false);
11773   MethodArgs.reset();
11774 
11775   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method))
11776     return true;
11777 
11778   // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
11779   // slots in the call for them.
11780   if (Args.size() < NumParams)
11781     TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams + 1);
11782 
11783   bool IsError = false;
11784 
11785   // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
11786   ExprResult ObjRes =
11787     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
11788                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11789   if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
11790     IsError = true;
11791   else
11792     Object = ObjRes;
11793   TheCall->setArg(0, Object.get());
11794 
11795   // Check the argument types.
11796   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) {
11797     Expr *Arg;
11798     if (i < Args.size()) {
11799       Arg = Args[i];
11800 
11801       // Pass the argument.
11802 
11803       ExprResult InputInit
11804         = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
11805                                                     Context,
11806                                                     Method->getParamDecl(i)),
11807                                     SourceLocation(), Arg);
11808 
11809       IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
11810       Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
11811     } else {
11812       ExprResult DefArg
11813         = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
11814       if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
11815         IsError = true;
11816         break;
11817       }
11818 
11819       Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>();
11820     }
11821 
11822     TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
11823   }
11824 
11825   // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
11826   if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
11827     // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
11828     for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) {
11829       ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
11830                                                         nullptr);
11831       IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
11832       TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.get());
11833     }
11834   }
11835 
11836   if (IsError) return true;
11837 
11838   DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
11839 
11840   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
11841     return true;
11842 
11843   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
11844 }
11845 
11846 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
11847 ///  (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
11848 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
11849 ExprResult
11850 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc,
11851                                bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) {
11852   assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
11853          "left-hand side must have class type");
11854 
11855   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
11856     return ExprError();
11857 
11858   SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
11859 
11860   // C++ [over.ref]p1:
11861   //
11862   //   [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
11863   //   for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
11864   //   the operator is selected as the best match function by the
11865   //   overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
11866   DeclarationName OpName =
11867     Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
11868   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
11869   const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
11870 
11871   if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
11872                           diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
11873     return ExprError();
11874 
11875   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11876   LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
11877   R.suppressDiagnostics();
11878 
11879   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
11880        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
11881     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
11882                        None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
11883   }
11884 
11885   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11886 
11887   // Perform overload resolution.
11888   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11889   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
11890   case OR_Success:
11891     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
11892     break;
11893 
11894   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11895     if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
11896       QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
11897       if (NoArrowOperatorFound) {
11898         // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a
11899         // diagnostic, as requested.
11900         *NoArrowOperatorFound = true;
11901         return ExprError();
11902       }
11903       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
11904         << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange();
11905       if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) {
11906         Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
11907           << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
11908       }
11909     } else
11910       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
11911         << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
11912     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
11913     return ExprError();
11914 
11915   case OR_Ambiguous:
11916     Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
11917       << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
11918     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base);
11919     return ExprError();
11920 
11921   case OR_Deleted:
11922     Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11923       << Best->Function->isDeleted()
11924       << "->"
11925       << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
11926       << Base->getSourceRange();
11927     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
11928     return ExprError();
11929   }
11930 
11931   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
11932 
11933   // Convert the object parameter.
11934   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
11935   ExprResult BaseResult =
11936     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
11937                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11938   if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
11939     return ExprError();
11940   Base = BaseResult.get();
11941 
11942   // Build the operator call.
11943   ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
11944                                             HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
11945   if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11946     return ExprError();
11947 
11948   QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
11949   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11950   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11951   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
11952     new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(),
11953                                       Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
11954 
11955   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method))
11956           return ExprError();
11957 
11958   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
11959 }
11960 
11961 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
11962 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
11963 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
11964                                           DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
11965                                           ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
11966                                           SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
11967                                        TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
11968   SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
11969 
11970   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc,
11971                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
11972   AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, true,
11973                         TemplateArgs);
11974 
11975   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11976 
11977   // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
11978   // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
11979   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11980   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
11981   case OR_Success:
11982   case OR_Deleted:
11983     break;
11984 
11985   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11986     Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
11987       << R.getLookupName();
11988     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11989     return ExprError();
11990 
11991   case OR_Ambiguous:
11992     Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName();
11993     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
11994     return ExprError();
11995   }
11996 
11997   FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
11998   ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
11999                                         HadMultipleCandidates,
12000                                         SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
12001                                         SuffixInfo.getInfo());
12002   if (Fn.isInvalid())
12003     return true;
12004 
12005   // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
12006   // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
12007   Expr *ConvArgs[2];
12008   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
12009     ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
12010       InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
12011       SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
12012     if (InputInit.isInvalid())
12013       return true;
12014     ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get();
12015   }
12016 
12017   QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType();
12018   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
12019   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
12020 
12021   UserDefinedLiteral *UDL =
12022     new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.get(),
12023                                      llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()),
12024                                      ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc);
12025 
12026   if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
12027     return ExprError();
12028 
12029   if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr))
12030     return ExprError();
12031 
12032   return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL);
12033 }
12034 
12035 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
12036 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
12037 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
12038 /// dependent lookup.
12039 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
12040 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
12041 /// is returned.
12042 Sema::ForRangeStatus
12043 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
12044                                 SourceLocation RangeLoc, VarDecl *Decl,
12045                                 BeginEndFunction BEF,
12046                                 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
12047                                 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
12048                                 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
12049                                 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
12050   CandidateSet->clear();
12051   if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
12052     ExprResult MemberRef =
12053         BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
12054                                  /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
12055                                  /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
12056                                  /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr,
12057                                  MemberLookup,
12058                                  /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
12059     if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
12060       *CallExpr = ExprError();
12061       Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
12062           << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
12063       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
12064     }
12065     *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr);
12066     if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
12067       *CallExpr = ExprError();
12068       Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
12069           << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
12070       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
12071     }
12072   } else {
12073     UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames;
12074     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn =
12075       UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/nullptr,
12076                                    NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo,
12077                                    /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false,
12078                                    FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end());
12079 
12080     bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc,
12081                                                     CandidateSet, CallExpr);
12082     if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
12083       *CallExpr = ExprError();
12084       return FRS_NoViableFunction;
12085     }
12086     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12087     OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
12088         CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
12089 
12090     if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
12091       *CallExpr = ExprError();
12092       return FRS_NoViableFunction;
12093     }
12094     *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range,
12095                                          Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best,
12096                                          OverloadResult,
12097                                          /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
12098     if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
12099       *CallExpr = ExprError();
12100       Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
12101           << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
12102       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
12103     }
12104   }
12105   return FRS_Success;
12106 }
12107 
12108 
12109 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
12110 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
12111 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
12112 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
12113 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
12114 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
12115                                            FunctionDecl *Fn) {
12116   if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
12117     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
12118                                                    Found, Fn);
12119     if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
12120       return PE;
12121 
12122     return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
12123   }
12124 
12125   if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
12126     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
12127                                                    Found, Fn);
12128     assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
12129                                SubExpr->getType()) &&
12130            "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
12131     assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
12132     if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
12133       return ICE;
12134 
12135     return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
12136                                     ICE->getCastKind(),
12137                                     SubExpr, nullptr,
12138                                     ICE->getValueKind());
12139   }
12140 
12141   if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
12142     assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
12143            "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
12144     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
12145       if (Method->isStatic()) {
12146         // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
12147         // from non-member functions.
12148       } else {
12149         // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an
12150         // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
12151         // or template.
12152         Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
12153                                                        Found, Fn);
12154         if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
12155           return UnOp;
12156 
12157         assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
12158                && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
12159         assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
12160                && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
12161 
12162         // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
12163         // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
12164         // appropriate pointer to member type.
12165         QualType ClassType
12166           = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
12167         QualType MemPtrType
12168           = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
12169 
12170         return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
12171                                            VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
12172                                            UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
12173       }
12174     }
12175     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
12176                                                    Found, Fn);
12177     if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
12178       return UnOp;
12179 
12180     return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
12181                                      Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
12182                                        VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
12183                                        UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
12184   }
12185 
12186   if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
12187     // FIXME: avoid copy.
12188     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
12189     if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12190       ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
12191       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
12192     }
12193 
12194     DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
12195                                            ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
12196                                            ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
12197                                            Fn,
12198                                            /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME?
12199                                            ULE->getNameLoc(),
12200                                            Fn->getType(),
12201                                            VK_LValue,
12202                                            Found.getDecl(),
12203                                            TemplateArgs);
12204     MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
12205     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
12206     return DRE;
12207   }
12208 
12209   if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
12210     // FIXME: avoid copy.
12211     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
12212     if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12213       MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
12214       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
12215     }
12216 
12217     Expr *Base;
12218 
12219     // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
12220     // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
12221     if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
12222       if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
12223         DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
12224                                                MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
12225                                                MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
12226                                                Fn,
12227                                                /*enclosing*/ false,
12228                                                MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
12229                                                Fn->getType(),
12230                                                VK_LValue,
12231                                                Found.getDecl(),
12232                                                TemplateArgs);
12233         MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
12234         DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
12235         return DRE;
12236       } else {
12237         SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
12238         if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
12239           Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
12240         CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
12241         Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
12242                                          MemExpr->getBaseType(),
12243                                          /*isImplicit=*/true);
12244       }
12245     } else
12246       Base = MemExpr->getBase();
12247 
12248     ExprValueKind valueKind;
12249     QualType type;
12250     if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
12251       valueKind = VK_LValue;
12252       type = Fn->getType();
12253     } else {
12254       valueKind = VK_RValue;
12255       type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
12256     }
12257 
12258     MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
12259                                         MemExpr->isArrow(),
12260                                         MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
12261                                         MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
12262                                         Fn,
12263                                         Found,
12264                                         MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
12265                                         TemplateArgs,
12266                                         type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
12267     ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
12268     MarkMemberReferenced(ME);
12269     return ME;
12270   }
12271 
12272   llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
12273 }
12274 
12275 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
12276                                                 DeclAccessPair Found,
12277                                                 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
12278   return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn);
12279 }
12280 
12281 } // end namespace clang
12282